| 
							- @chapter Filtering Introduction
 - @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
 - 
 - Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
 - 
 - In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
 - outputs.
 - To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
 - following filtergraph.
 - 
 - @verbatim
 -                 [main]
 - input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
 -             |                             ^
 -             |[tmp]                  [flip]|
 -             +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
 - @end verbatim
 - 
 - This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
 - stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
 - back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
 - following command to achieve this:
 - 
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
 - @end example
 - 
 - The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
 - onto the bottom half of the output video.
 - 
 - Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
 - linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
 - @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
 - @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
 - chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
 - example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
 - the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
 - 
 - The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
 - @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
 - away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
 - @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
 - split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
 - lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
 - 
 - Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
 - after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
 - by a colon.
 - 
 - There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
 - audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
 - output.
 - 
 - @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
 - 
 - @chapter graph2dot
 - @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
 - 
 - The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
 - directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
 - corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
 - 
 - Invoke the command:
 - @example
 - graph2dot -h
 - @end example
 - 
 - to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
 - 
 - You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
 - the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
 - of the filtergraph.
 - 
 - For example the sequence of commands:
 - @example
 - echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
 - tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
 - dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
 - display graph.png
 - @end example
 - 
 - can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
 - described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
 - a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
 - For example if your command line is of the form:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
 - @end example
 - your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
 - @example
 - nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
 - @end example
 - you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
 - filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
 - 
 - @c man end GRAPH2DOT
 - 
 - @chapter Filtergraph description
 - @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
 - 
 - A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
 - cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
 - filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
 - filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
 - side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
 - 
 - Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
 - registered in the application, which defines the features and the
 - number of input and output pads of the filter.
 - 
 - A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
 - output pads is called a "sink".
 - 
 - @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
 - @section Filtergraph syntax
 - 
 - A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
 - @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
 - @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
 - @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
 - @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
 - @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
 - 
 - A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
 - connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
 - represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
 - 
 - A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
 - filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
 - descriptions.
 - 
 - A filter is represented by a string of the form:
 - [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
 - 
 - @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
 - described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
 - the filter classes registered in the program.
 - The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
 - "=@var{arguments}".
 - 
 - @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
 - initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
 - @itemize
 - 
 - @item
 - A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
 - 
 - @item
 - A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
 - the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
 - declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
 - @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
 - @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
 - @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
 - 
 - @item
 - A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
 - pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
 - follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
 - @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
 - takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
 - @samp{|}.
 - 
 - The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
 - and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
 - within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
 - terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
 - @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
 - 
 - The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
 - followed by a list of link labels.
 - A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
 - or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
 - ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
 - the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
 - associated to the output pads.
 - 
 - When two link labels with the same name are found in the
 - filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
 - created.
 - 
 - If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
 - unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
 - For example in the filterchain
 - @example
 - nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
 - @end example
 - the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
 - instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
 - "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
 - output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
 - which are both unlabelled.
 - 
 - In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
 - specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
 - specified, "out" is assumed.
 - 
 - In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
 - pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
 - filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
 - 
 - Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
 - conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
 - for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
 - @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
 - to the filtergraph description.
 - 
 - Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
 - @example
 - @var{NAME}             ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
 - @var{LINKLABEL}        ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
 - @var{LINKLABELS}       ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
 - @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
 - @var{FILTER}           ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
 - @var{FILTERCHAIN}      ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
 - @var{FILTERGRAPH}      ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
 - 
 - Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
 - escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
 - section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
 - information about the employed escaping procedure.
 - 
 - A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
 - value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
 - separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
 - 
 - A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
 - may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
 - characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
 - 
 - Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
 - need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
 - characters contained within it.
 - 
 - For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
 - the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
 - @example
 - this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
 - @end example
 - 
 - This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
 - @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
 - @example
 - text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
 - @end example
 - 
 - A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
 - description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
 - filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
 - @example
 - drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
 - @end example
 - (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
 - also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
 - 
 - Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
 - filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
 - escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
 - @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
 - previous string will finally result in:
 - @example
 - -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @chapter Timeline editing
 - 
 - Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
 - supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
 - evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
 - the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
 - next filter in the filtergraph.
 - 
 - The expression accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item t
 - timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
 - 
 - @item n
 - sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
 - 
 - @item pos
 - the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
 - 
 - @item w
 - @item h
 - width and height of the input frame if video
 - @end table
 - 
 - Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
 - to re-define the expression.
 - 
 - Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
 - rules.
 - 
 - For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
 - minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
 - @example
 - smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
 - curves    = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
 - @end example
 - 
 - @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
 - 
 - @chapter Audio Filters
 - @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
 - 
 - When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
 - existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
 - The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
 - build.
 - 
 - Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
 - 
 - @section acompressor
 - 
 - A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
 - Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
 - improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
 - of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
 - If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
 - afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
 - but can also destroy a track completely).
 - The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
 - the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
 - it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
 - 
 - Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
 - @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
 - So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
 - of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
 - the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
 - levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
 - @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
 - before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
 - has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
 - than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
 - The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
 - @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
 - raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
 - source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
 - hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item level_in
 - Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
 - 
 - @item threshold
 - If a signal of second stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
 - reduction of the first stream.
 - By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
 - 
 - @item ratio
 - Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
 - rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
 - Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
 - 
 - @item attack
 - Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
 - reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
 - 
 - @item release
 - Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
 - reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
 - 
 - @item makeup
 - Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
 - Default is 2. Range is from 1 and 64.
 - 
 - @item knee
 - Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
 - Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
 - 
 - @item link
 - Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
 - or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
 - reduction. Default is @code{average}.
 - 
 - @item detection
 - Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
 - of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
 - 
 - @item mix
 - How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
 - Range is between 0 and 1.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section acrossfade
 - 
 - Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
 - The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item nb_samples, ns
 - Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
 - At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
 - silent. Default is 44100.
 - 
 - @item duration, d
 - Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
 - @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
 - for the accepted syntax.
 - By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
 - If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
 - 
 - @item overlap, o
 - Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
 - 
 - @item curve1
 - Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
 - 
 - @item curve2
 - Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
 - 
 - For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Cross fade from one input to another:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section adelay
 - 
 - Delay one or more audio channels.
 - 
 - Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following option:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item delays
 - Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
 - At least one delay greater than 0 should be provided.
 - Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
 - smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
 - the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
 - @example
 - adelay=1500|0|500
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section aecho
 - 
 - Apply echoing to the input audio.
 - 
 - Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
 - (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
 - effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
 - sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
 - original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
 - loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
 - Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
 - 
 - A description of the accepted parameters follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item in_gain
 - Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
 - 
 - @item out_gain
 - Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
 - 
 - @item delays
 - Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
 - separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
 - Default is @code{1000}.
 - 
 - @item decays
 - Set list of loudnesses of reflected signals separated by '|'.
 - Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
 - Default is @code{0.5}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
 - @example
 - aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - If delay is very short, then it sound like a (metallic) robot playing music:
 - @example
 - aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
 - @example
 - aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Same as above but with one more mountain:
 - @example
 - aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section aemphasis
 - Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
 - emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
 - signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
 - this recording medium.
 - Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
 - restore the distortion of the frequency response.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item level_in
 - Set input gain.
 - 
 - @item level_out
 - Set output gain.
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
 - use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
 - 
 - @item type
 - Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item col
 - select Columbia.
 - @item emi
 - select EMI.
 - @item bsi
 - select BSI (78RPM).
 - @item riaa
 - select RIAA.
 - @item cd
 - select Compact Disc (CD).
 - @item 50fm
 - select 50µs (FM).
 - @item 75fm
 - select 75µs (FM).
 - @item 50kf
 - select 50µs (FM-KF).
 - @item 75kf
 - select 75µs (FM-KF).
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section aeval
 - 
 - Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
 - 
 - This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
 - which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item exprs
 - Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
 - the number of input channels is greater than the number of
 - expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
 - output channels.
 - 
 - @item channel_layout, c
 - Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
 - specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
 - use by default the same input channel layout.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item ch
 - channel number of the current expression
 - 
 - @item n
 - number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
 - 
 - @item s
 - sample rate
 - 
 - @item t
 - time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
 - 
 - @item nb_in_channels
 - @item nb_out_channels
 - input and output number of channels
 - 
 - @item val(CH)
 - the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
 - @end table
 - 
 - Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
 - dedicated filter.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Half volume:
 - @example
 - aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Invert phase of the second channel:
 - @example
 - aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{afade}
 - @section afade
 - 
 - Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
 - 
 - A description of the accepted parameters follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item type, t
 - Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
 - @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
 - 
 - @item start_sample, ss
 - Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
 - effect. Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item nb_samples, ns
 - Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
 - the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
 - volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
 - the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
 - 
 - @item start_time, st
 - Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
 - The value must be specified as a time duration; see
 - @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
 - for the accepted syntax.
 - If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
 - 
 - @item duration, d
 - Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
 - @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
 - for the accepted syntax.
 - At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
 - volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
 - the output audio will be silence.
 - By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
 - If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
 - 
 - @item curve
 - Set curve for fade transition.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @option
 - @item tri
 - select triangular, linear slope (default)
 - @item qsin
 - select quarter of sine wave
 - @item hsin
 - select half of sine wave
 - @item esin
 - select exponential sine wave
 - @item log
 - select logarithmic
 - @item ipar
 - select inverted parabola
 - @item qua
 - select quadratic
 - @item cub
 - select cubic
 - @item squ
 - select square root
 - @item cbr
 - select cubic root
 - @item par
 - select parabola
 - @item exp
 - select exponential
 - @item iqsin
 - select inverted quarter of sine wave
 - @item ihsin
 - select inverted half of sine wave
 - @item dese
 - select double-exponential seat
 - @item desi
 - select double-exponential sigmoid
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
 - @example
 - afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
 - @example
 - afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{aformat}
 - @section aformat
 - 
 - Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
 - negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item sample_fmts
 - A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
 - 
 - @item sample_rates
 - A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
 - 
 - @item channel_layouts
 - A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
 - 
 - See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
 - for the required syntax.
 - @end table
 - 
 - If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
 - 
 - Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
 - @example
 - aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section agate
 - 
 - A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
 - processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
 - 
 - Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
 - and divide it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
 - floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
 - would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
 - time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
 - 
 - @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
 - before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
 - has to raise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
 - Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item level_in
 - Set input level before filtering.
 - Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
 - 
 - @item range
 - Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
 - Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
 - 
 - @item threshold
 - If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
 - Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
 - 
 - @item ratio
 - Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
 - Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
 - 
 - @item attack
 - Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
 - reduction stops.
 - Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
 - 
 - @item release
 - Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
 - reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
 - Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
 - 
 - @item makeup
 - Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
 - Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
 - 
 - @item knee
 - Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
 - Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
 - 
 - @item detection
 - Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
 - Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
 - 
 - @item link
 - Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
 - the reduction.
 - Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section alimiter
 - 
 - The limiter prevents input signal from raising over a desired threshold.
 - This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
 - It means that there is a small delay after signal is processed. Keep in mind
 - that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item level_in
 - Set input gain. Default is 1.
 - 
 - @item level_out
 - Set output gain. Default is 1.
 - 
 - @item limit
 - Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
 - 
 - @item attack
 - The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
 - milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
 - 
 - @item release
 - Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
 - Default is 50 milliseconds.
 - 
 - @item asc
 - When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
 - average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
 - time.
 - 
 - @item asc_level
 - Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
 - in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
 - 
 - @item level
 - Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
 - This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
 - with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
 - 
 - @section allpass
 - 
 - Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
 - @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
 - An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
 - without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item frequency, f
 - Set frequency in Hz.
 - 
 - @item width_type
 - Set method to specify band-width of filter.
 - @table @option
 - @item h
 - Hz
 - @item q
 - Q-Factor
 - @item o
 - octave
 - @item s
 - slope
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item width, w
 - Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{amerge}
 - @section amerge
 - 
 - Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item inputs
 - Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
 - the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
 - will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
 - disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
 - the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
 - the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
 - channels.
 - 
 - For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
 - is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
 - following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
 - first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
 - 
 - On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
 - in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
 - arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
 - 
 - All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
 - 
 - If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
 - shortest.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
 - @example
 - amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section amix
 - 
 - Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
 - 
 - Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
 - and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
 - input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
 - inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
 - 
 - For example
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
 - @end example
 - will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
 - first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item inputs
 - The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
 - 
 - @item duration
 - How to determine the end-of-stream.
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item longest
 - The duration of the longest input. (default)
 - 
 - @item shortest
 - The duration of the shortest input.
 - 
 - @item first
 - The duration of the first input.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item dropout_transition
 - The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
 - stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section anull
 - 
 - Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
 - 
 - @section apad
 - 
 - Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
 - 
 - This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
 - extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
 - 
 - A description of the accepted options follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item packet_size
 - Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
 - 
 - @item pad_len
 - Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
 - value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
 - exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
 - 
 - @item whole_len
 - Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
 - the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
 - the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
 - with @option{pad_len}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} option is
 - set, the filter will add silence to the end of the input stream
 - indefinitely.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
 - @example
 - apad=pad_len=1024
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
 - the input with silence if required:
 - @example
 - apad=whole_len=10000
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
 - video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
 - until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
 - option:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section aphaser
 - Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
 - 
 - A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
 - The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
 - 
 - A description of the accepted parameters follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item in_gain
 - Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
 - 
 - @item out_gain
 - Set output gain. Default is 0.74
 - 
 - @item delay
 - Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
 - 
 - @item decay
 - Set decay. Default is 0.4.
 - 
 - @item speed
 - Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
 - 
 - @item type
 - Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item triangular, t
 - @item sinusoidal, s
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section apulsator
 - 
 - Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
 - But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
 - of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
 - different waveforms and shifted phases.
 - This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
 - channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
 - The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
 - An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
 - in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
 - an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
 - phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
 - sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
 - the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item level_in
 - Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
 - 
 - @item level_out
 - Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
 - sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
 - 
 - @item amount
 - Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
 - 
 - @item offset_l
 - Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
 - 
 - @item offset_r
 - Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
 - 
 - @item width
 - Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
 - 
 - @item timing
 - Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
 - 
 - @item bpm
 - Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
 - is set to bpm.
 - 
 - @item ms
 - Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
 - is set to ms.
 - 
 - @item hz
 - Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
 - if timing is set to hz.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{aresample}
 - @section aresample
 - 
 - Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
 - libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
 - automatically convert between its input and output.
 - 
 - This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
 - the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
 - timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the syntax
 - [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
 - expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
 - @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
 - ffmpeg-resampler manual for the complete list of supported options.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
 - @example
 - aresample=44100
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
 - samples per second compensation:
 - @example
 - aresample=async=1000
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section asetnsamples
 - 
 - Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
 - 
 - The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
 - the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
 - signal its end.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item nb_out_samples, n
 - Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
 - intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
 - Default value is 1024.
 - 
 - @item pad, p
 - If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
 - that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
 - previous ones. Default value is 1.
 - @end table
 - 
 - For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
 - disable padding for the last frame, use:
 - @example
 - asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section asetrate
 - 
 - Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
 - This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item sample_rate, r
 - Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section ashowinfo
 - 
 - Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
 - The input audio is not modified.
 - 
 - The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
 - @var{key}:@var{value}.
 - 
 - The following values are shown in the output:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
 - 
 - @item pts
 - The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
 - depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
 - 
 - @item pts_time
 - The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
 - 
 - @item pos
 - position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
 - unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
 - 
 - @item fmt
 - The sample format.
 - 
 - @item chlayout
 - The channel layout.
 - 
 - @item rate
 - The sample rate for the audio frame.
 - 
 - @item nb_samples
 - The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
 - 
 - @item checksum
 - The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
 - audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
 - 
 - @item plane_checksums
 - A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{astats}
 - @section astats
 - 
 - Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
 - Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
 - where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
 - 
 - It accepts the following option:
 - @table @option
 - @item length
 - Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
 - Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 10]}.
 - 
 - @item metadata
 - 
 - Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
 - where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
 - disabled.
 - 
 - Available keys for each channel are:
 - DC_offset
 - Min_level
 - Max_level
 - Min_difference
 - Max_difference
 - Mean_difference
 - Peak_level
 - RMS_peak
 - RMS_trough
 - Crest_factor
 - Flat_factor
 - Peak_count
 - Bit_depth
 - 
 - and for Overall:
 - DC_offset
 - Min_level
 - Max_level
 - Min_difference
 - Max_difference
 - Mean_difference
 - Peak_level
 - RMS_level
 - RMS_peak
 - RMS_trough
 - Flat_factor
 - Peak_count
 - Bit_depth
 - Number_of_samples
 - 
 - For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
 - this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
 - 
 - For description what each key means read below.
 - 
 - @item reset
 - Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
 - Default is disabled.
 - @end table
 - 
 - A description of each shown parameter follows:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item DC offset
 - Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
 - 
 - @item Min level
 - Minimal sample level.
 - 
 - @item Max level
 - Maximal sample level.
 - 
 - @item Min difference
 - Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
 - 
 - @item Max difference
 - Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
 - 
 - @item Mean difference
 - Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
 - The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
 - 
 - @item Peak level dB
 - @item RMS level dB
 - Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
 - 
 - @item RMS peak dB
 - @item RMS trough dB
 - Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
 - 
 - @item Crest factor
 - Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
 - 
 - @item Flat factor
 - Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
 - (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
 - 
 - @item Peak count
 - Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
 - @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
 - 
 - @item Bit depth
 - Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section asyncts
 - 
 - Synchronize audio data with timestamps by squeezing/stretching it and/or
 - dropping samples/adding silence when needed.
 - 
 - This filter is not built by default, please use @ref{aresample} to do squeezing/stretching.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item compensate
 - Enable stretching/squeezing the data to make it match the timestamps. Disabled
 - by default. When disabled, time gaps are covered with silence.
 - 
 - @item min_delta
 - The minimum difference between timestamps and audio data (in seconds) to trigger
 - adding/dropping samples. The default value is 0.1. If you get an imperfect
 - sync with this filter, try setting this parameter to 0.
 - 
 - @item max_comp
 - The maximum compensation in samples per second. Only relevant with compensate=1.
 - The default value is 500.
 - 
 - @item first_pts
 - Assume that the first PTS should be this value. The time base is 1 / sample
 - rate. This allows for padding/trimming at the start of the stream. By default,
 - no assumption is made about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or
 - trimming is done. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with
 - silence if an audio stream starts after the video stream or to trim any samples
 - with a negative PTS due to encoder delay.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section atempo
 - 
 - Adjust audio tempo.
 - 
 - The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
 - specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
 - be in the [0.5, 2.0] range.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
 - @example
 - atempo=0.8
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - To speed up audio to 125% tempo:
 - @example
 - atempo=1.25
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section atrim
 - 
 - Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - @item start
 - Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
 - sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
 - 
 - @item end
 - Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
 - audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
 - the last sample in the output.
 - 
 - @item start_pts
 - Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
 - instead of seconds.
 - 
 - @item end_pts
 - Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
 - of seconds.
 - 
 - @item duration
 - The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
 - 
 - @item start_sample
 - The number of the first sample that should be output.
 - 
 - @item end_sample
 - The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
 - duration specifications; see
 - @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - 
 - Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
 - option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
 - samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
 - give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
 - zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
 - to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
 - atrim filter.
 - 
 - If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
 - keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
 - only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
 - filters.
 - 
 - The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
 - just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
 - 
 - Examples:
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Drop everything except the second minute of input:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Keep only the first 1000 samples:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section bandpass
 - 
 - Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
 - frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
 - The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
 - instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
 - The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item frequency, f
 - Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
 - 
 - @item csg
 - Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
 - 
 - @item width_type
 - Set method to specify band-width of filter.
 - @table @option
 - @item h
 - Hz
 - @item q
 - Q-Factor
 - @item o
 - octave
 - @item s
 - slope
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item width, w
 - Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section bandreject
 - 
 - Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
 - frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
 - The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item frequency, f
 - Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
 - 
 - @item width_type
 - Set method to specify band-width of filter.
 - @table @option
 - @item h
 - Hz
 - @item q
 - Q-Factor
 - @item o
 - octave
 - @item s
 - slope
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item width, w
 - Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section bass
 - 
 - Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
 - shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
 - hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item gain, g
 - Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
 - (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
 - Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
 - 
 - @item frequency, f
 - Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
 - to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
 - The default value is @code{100} Hz.
 - 
 - @item width_type
 - Set method to specify band-width of filter.
 - @table @option
 - @item h
 - Hz
 - @item q
 - Q-Factor
 - @item o
 - octave
 - @item s
 - slope
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item width, w
 - Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section biquad
 - 
 - Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
 - Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
 - are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
 - 
 - @section bs2b
 - Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
 - stereo audio records.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item profile
 - Pre-defined crossfeed level.
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item default
 - Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
 - 
 - @item cmoy
 - Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
 - 
 - @item jmeier
 - Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item fcut
 - Cut frequency (in Hz).
 - 
 - @item feed
 - Feed level (in Hz).
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section channelmap
 - 
 - Remap input channels to new locations.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - @item channel_layout
 - The channel layout of the output stream.
 - 
 - @item map
 - Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
 - mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
 - @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
 - channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
 - @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
 - channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
 - index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
 - @end table
 - 
 - If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
 - output channels, preserving indices.
 - 
 - For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
 - @end example
 - will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
 - the input.
 - 
 - To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section channelsplit
 - 
 - Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - @item channel_layout
 - The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
 - @end table
 - 
 - For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
 - @end example
 - will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
 - the left channel and the other the right channel.
 - 
 - Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
 - 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
 - -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
 - front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
 - side_right.wav
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section chorus
 - Add a chorus effect to the audio.
 - 
 - Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
 - 
 - Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
 - constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
 - The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
 - the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
 - sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
 - off key.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - @item in_gain
 - Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
 - 
 - @item out_gain
 - Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
 - 
 - @item delays
 - Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
 - 
 - @item decays
 - Set decays.
 - 
 - @item speeds
 - Set speeds.
 - 
 - @item depths
 - Set depths.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - A single delay:
 - @example
 - chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Two delays:
 - @example
 - chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
 - @example
 - chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section compand
 - Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item attacks
 - @item decays
 - A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
 - of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
 - increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
 - situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
 - shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
 - loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
 - a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
 - If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
 - set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
 - 
 - @item points
 - A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
 - maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
 - the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
 - @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
 - 
 - The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
 - does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
 - may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
 - function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20}.
 - 
 - @item soft-knee
 - Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
 - 
 - @item gain
 - Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
 - function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
 - It defaults to 0.
 - 
 - @item volume
 - Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
 - starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
 - example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
 - companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
 - quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
 - 
 - @item delay
 - Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
 - delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
 - approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
 - operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
 - noisy environment:
 - @example
 - compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
 - @end example
 - 
 - Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
 - @example
 - compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
 - @example
 - compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
 - than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
 - @example
 - compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
 - @example
 - compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
 - @example
 - compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
 - @example
 - compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
 - @example
 - compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
 - @example
 - compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Compressor/Gate:
 - @example
 - compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Expander:
 - @example
 - compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Hard limiter at -6dB:
 - @example
 - compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Hard limiter at -12dB:
 - @example
 - compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
 - @example
 - compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Soft limiter:
 - @example
 - compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section compensationdelay
 - 
 - Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
 - positions of microphones or speakers.
 - 
 - For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
 - different location. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
 - normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
 - their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
 - these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that distance of
 - ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone to capture signal in
 - antiphase to another microphone. That makes the final mix sounding moody.
 - This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
 - to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
 - 
 - The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
 - synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
 - Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
 - Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item mm
 - Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
 - Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item cm
 - Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
 - Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item m
 - Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
 - Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item dry
 - Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
 - Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item wet
 - Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
 - Default is 1.
 - 
 - @item temp
 - Set temperature degree in Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
 - Default is 20.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section dcshift
 - Apply a DC shift to the audio.
 - 
 - This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
 - in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
 - headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
 - a signal has a DC offset.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item shift
 - Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
 - the audio.
 - 
 - @item limitergain
 - Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
 - used to prevent clipping.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section dynaudnorm
 - Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
 - 
 - This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
 - to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
 - contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
 - Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
 - This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
 - while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
 - The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
 - sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
 - same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
 - this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
 - of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item f
 - Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
 - Default is 500 milliseconds.
 - The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
 - referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
 - meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
 - peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
 - normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
 - Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
 - frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
 - Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
 - been found to give good results with most files.
 - Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
 - automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
 - 
 - @item g
 - Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
 - number. Default is 31.
 - Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
 - @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
 - is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
 - simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
 - takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
 - the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
 - smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
 - adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
 - effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
 - In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
 - Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
 - contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
 - Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
 - 
 - @item p
 - Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
 - level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
 - target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
 - makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
 - A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
 - magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
 - It is not recommended to go above this value.
 - 
 - @item m
 - Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
 - The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
 - factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
 - result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
 - the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
 - additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
 - (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
 - factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
 - factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
 - it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
 - with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
 - higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
 - not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
 - Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
 - gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
 - value.
 - 
 - @item r
 - Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
 - By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
 - This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
 - (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
 - be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
 - level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
 - Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
 - abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
 - determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
 - that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
 - just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
 - frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
 - established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
 - factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
 - Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
 - frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
 - 
 - @item n
 - Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
 - By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
 - amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
 - the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
 - However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
 - channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
 - In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
 - the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
 - only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
 - harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
 - 
 - @item c
 - Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
 - An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
 - In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
 - -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
 - audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
 - That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
 - single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
 - value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
 - 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
 - DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
 - Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
 - With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
 - the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
 - that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
 - are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
 - boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
 - between neighbouring frames.
 - 
 - @item b
 - Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
 - The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
 - around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
 - subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
 - beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
 - frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
 - file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
 - frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
 - question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
 - in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
 - to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
 - of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
 - "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
 - 
 - @item s
 - Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
 - By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
 - compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
 - full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
 - in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
 - normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
 - For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
 - (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
 - all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
 - to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
 - going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
 - However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
 - value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
 - frame.
 - In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
 - Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section earwax
 - 
 - Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
 - 
 - This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
 - so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
 - inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
 - the listener (standard for speakers).
 - 
 - Ported from SoX.
 - 
 - @section equalizer
 - 
 - Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
 - filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
 - be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
 - filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
 - 
 - In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
 - be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item frequency, f
 - Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
 - 
 - @item width_type
 - Set method to specify band-width of filter.
 - @table @option
 - @item h
 - Hz
 - @item q
 - Q-Factor
 - @item o
 - octave
 - @item s
 - slope
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item width, w
 - Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
 - 
 - @item gain, g
 - Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
 - Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
 - @example
 - equalizer=f=1000:width_type=h:width=200:g=-10
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
 - @example
 - equalizer=f=1000:width_type=q:width=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:width_type=q:width=2:g=-5
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section extrastereo
 - 
 - Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
 - adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following option:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item m
 - Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
 - (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
 - -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
 - 
 - @item c
 - Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section flanger
 - Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item delay
 - Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @item depth
 - Set added swep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
 - 
 - @item regen
 - Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
 - Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @item width
 - Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
 - Default value is 71.
 - 
 - @item speed
 - Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
 - 
 - @item shape
 - Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
 - Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
 - 
 - @item phase
 - Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
 - Default value is 25.
 - 
 - @item interp
 - Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
 - Default is @var{linear}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section highpass
 - 
 - Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
 - The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
 - The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item frequency, f
 - Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
 - 
 - @item poles, p
 - Set number of poles. Default is 2.
 - 
 - @item width_type
 - Set method to specify band-width of filter.
 - @table @option
 - @item h
 - Hz
 - @item q
 - Q-Factor
 - @item o
 - octave
 - @item s
 - slope
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item width, w
 - Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
 - Applies only to double-pole filter.
 - The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section join
 - 
 - Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item inputs
 - The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
 - 
 - @item channel_layout
 - The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
 - 
 - @item map
 - Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
 - mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
 - form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
 - can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
 - index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
 - channel.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
 - explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
 - and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
 - 
 - Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
 - @end example
 - 
 - Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
 - 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
 - out
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section ladspa
 - 
 - Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
 - 
 - To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
 - @code{--enable-ladspa}.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item file, f
 - Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
 - variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
 - each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
 - @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
 - this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
 - @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
 - 
 - @item plugin, p
 - Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
 - one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
 - will list all available plugins within the specified library.
 - 
 - @item controls, c
 - Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
 - values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
 - threshold or gain).
 - Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
 - c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
 - @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
 - Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
 - @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
 - @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
 - If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
 - their valid ranges are printed.
 - 
 - @item sample_rate, s
 - Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
 - zero inputs.
 - 
 - @item nb_samples, n
 - Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
 - is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
 - 
 - @item duration, d
 - Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
 - @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
 - for the accepted syntax.
 - Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
 - as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
 - If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
 - supposed to be generated forever.
 - Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
 - @example
 - ladspa=file=amp
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
 - plugin from @code{VCF} library:
 - @example
 - ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
 - plugin library:
 - @example
 - ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
 - (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
 - @example
 - ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
 - @example
 - ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
 - @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
 - @example
 - ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
 - @example
 - ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
 - @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
 - @example
 - ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
 - @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
 - @example
 - ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @subsection Commands
 - 
 - This filter supports the following commands:
 - @table @option
 - @item cN
 - Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
 - 
 - If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section lowpass
 - 
 - Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
 - The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
 - The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item frequency, f
 - Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
 - 
 - @item poles, p
 - Set number of poles. Default is 2.
 - 
 - @item width_type
 - Set method to specify band-width of filter.
 - @table @option
 - @item h
 - Hz
 - @item q
 - Q-Factor
 - @item o
 - octave
 - @item s
 - slope
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item width, w
 - Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
 - Applies only to double-pole filter.
 - The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{pan}
 - @section pan
 - 
 - Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
 - channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
 - 
 - This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
 - stream.
 - 
 - The filter accepts parameters of the form:
 - "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item l
 - output channel layout or number of channels
 - 
 - @item outdef
 - output channel specification, of the form:
 - "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[+[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
 - 
 - @item out_name
 - output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
 - number (c0, c1, etc.)
 - 
 - @item gain
 - multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
 - 
 - @item in_name
 - input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
 - named and numbered input channels
 - @end table
 - 
 - If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
 - that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
 - avoiding clipping noise.
 - 
 - @subsection Mixing examples
 - 
 - For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
 - factor for the left channel:
 - @example
 - pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
 - @end example
 - 
 - A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
 - 7-channels surround:
 - @example
 - pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
 - @end example
 - 
 - Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
 - that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
 - needs.
 - 
 - @subsection Remapping examples
 - 
 - The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
 - @item only one input per channel output,
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
 - channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
 - remapping.
 - 
 - For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
 - dropping the extra channels:
 - @example
 - pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
 - @end example
 - 
 - Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
 - and keep the input channel layout:
 - @example
 - pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
 - @end example
 - 
 - If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
 - still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
 - @example
 - pan="stereo|c1=c1"
 - @end example
 - 
 - Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
 - front left and right:
 - @example
 - pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section replaygain
 - 
 - ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
 - outputs it unchanged.
 - At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
 - 
 - @section resample
 - 
 - Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
 - not meant to be used directly.
 - 
 - @section rubberband
 - Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item tempo
 - Set tempo scale factor.
 - 
 - @item pitch
 - Set pitch scale factor.
 - 
 - @item transients
 - Set transients detector.
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item crisp
 - @item mixed
 - @item smooth
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item detector
 - Set detector.
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item compound
 - @item percussive
 - @item soft
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item phase
 - Set phase.
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item laminar
 - @item independent
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item window
 - Set processing window size.
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item standard
 - @item short
 - @item long
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item smoothing
 - Set smoothing.
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item off
 - @item on
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item formant
 - Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item shifted
 - @item preserved
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item pitchq
 - Set pitch quality.
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item quality
 - @item speed
 - @item consistency
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item channels
 - Set channels.
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item apart
 - @item together
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section sidechaincompress
 - 
 - This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
 - detected signal using second input signal.
 - It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
 - First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
 - The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
 - processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item level_in
 - Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
 - 
 - @item threshold
 - If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
 - reduction of first stream.
 - By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
 - 
 - @item ratio
 - Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
 - raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
 - Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
 - 
 - @item attack
 - Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
 - reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
 - 
 - @item release
 - Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
 - reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
 - 
 - @item makeup
 - Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
 - Default is 2. Range is from 1 and 64.
 - 
 - @item knee
 - Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
 - Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
 - 
 - @item link
 - Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
 - or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
 - reduction. Default is @code{average}.
 - 
 - @item detection
 - Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
 - of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
 - 
 - @item level_sc
 - Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
 - 
 - @item mix
 - How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
 - Range is between 0 and 1.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
 - depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
 - merged with 2nd input:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section sidechaingate
 - 
 - A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
 - filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
 - Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
 - threshold.
 - For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
 - the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
 - appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
 - natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
 - guitar.
 - It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
 - First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item level_in
 - Set input level before filtering.
 - Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
 - 
 - @item range
 - Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
 - Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
 - 
 - @item threshold
 - If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
 - Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
 - 
 - @item ratio
 - Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
 - Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
 - 
 - @item attack
 - Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
 - reduction stops.
 - Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
 - 
 - @item release
 - Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
 - reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
 - Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
 - 
 - @item makeup
 - Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
 - Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
 - 
 - @item knee
 - Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
 - Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
 - 
 - @item detection
 - Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
 - Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
 - 
 - @item link
 - Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
 - the reduction.
 - Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
 - 
 - @item level_sc
 - Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section silencedetect
 - 
 - Detect silence in an audio stream.
 - 
 - This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
 - or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
 - minimum detected noise duration.
 - 
 - The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item duration, d
 - Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
 - 
 - @item noise, n
 - Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
 - specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
 - @example
 - silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
 - tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section silenceremove
 - 
 - Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item start_periods
 - This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
 - the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
 - beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
 - finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
 - the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
 - values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
 - Default value is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item start_duration
 - Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
 - trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
 - as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item start_threshold
 - This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
 - audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
 - you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
 - Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
 - or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item stop_periods
 - Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
 - To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
 - that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
 - used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
 - @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
 - in the middle of the audio.
 - Default value is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item stop_duration
 - Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
 - more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
 - the audio.
 - Default value is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item stop_threshold
 - This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
 - the end of audio.
 - Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
 - or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item leave_silence
 - This indicate that @var{stop_duration} length of audio should be left intact
 - at the beginning of each period of silence.
 - For example, if you want to remove long pauses between words but do not want
 - to remove the pauses completely. Default value is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
 - that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
 - pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
 - @example
 - silenceremove=1:5:0.02
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section sofalizer
 - 
 - SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
 - loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
 - formats up to 9 channels supported).
 - The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see www.sofacoustics.org for a database).
 - SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
 - Austrian Academy of Sciences.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item sofa
 - Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
 - 
 - @item gain
 - Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item rotation
 - Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item elevation
 - Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item radius
 - Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
 - HRTFs. Default is 1.
 - 
 - @item type
 - Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
 - processing audio in time domain which is slow but gives high quality output.
 - @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast but gives
 - mediocre output. Default is @var{freq}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section stereotools
 - 
 - This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
 - M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
 - or spreading the stereo image of master track.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item level_in
 - Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
 - Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
 - 
 - @item level_out
 - Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
 - Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
 - 
 - @item balance_in
 - Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
 - Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
 - 
 - @item balance_out
 - Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
 - Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
 - 
 - @item softclip
 - Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
 - clipping. Disabled by default.
 - 
 - @item mutel
 - Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
 - 
 - @item muter
 - Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
 - 
 - @item phasel
 - Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
 - 
 - @item phaser
 - Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Set stereo mode. Available values are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item lr>lr
 - Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
 - 
 - @item lr>ms
 - Left/Right to Mid/Side.
 - 
 - @item ms>lr
 - Mid/Side to Left/Right.
 - 
 - @item lr>ll
 - Left/Right to Left/Left.
 - 
 - @item lr>rr
 - Left/Right to Right/Right.
 - 
 - @item lr>l+r
 - Left/Right to Left + Right.
 - 
 - @item lr>rl
 - Left/Right to Right/Left.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item slev
 - Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
 - Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
 - 
 - @item sbal
 - Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
 - Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
 - 
 - @item mlev
 - Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
 - Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
 - 
 - @item mpan
 - Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
 - 
 - @item base
 - Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
 - Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
 - 
 - @item delay
 - Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
 - vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
 - 
 - @item sclevel
 - Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
 - 
 - @item phase
 - Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section stereowiden
 - 
 - This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
 - channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
 - thereby widening the stereo effect.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item delay
 - Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
 - Default is 20 milliseconds.
 - 
 - @item feedback
 - Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
 - effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
 - effect. Default is 0.3.
 - 
 - @item crossfeed
 - Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
 - the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
 - channels. Default is 0.3.
 - 
 - @item drymix
 - Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section treble
 - 
 - Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
 - shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
 - hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item gain, g
 - Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
 - Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
 - to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
 - 
 - @item frequency, f
 - Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
 - to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
 - The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
 - 
 - @item width_type
 - Set method to specify band-width of filter.
 - @table @option
 - @item h
 - Hz
 - @item q
 - Q-Factor
 - @item o
 - octave
 - @item s
 - slope
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item width, w
 - Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section tremolo
 - 
 - Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item f
 - Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
 - (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
 - This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
 - a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
 - Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
 - 
 - @item d
 - Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
 - Default value is 0.5.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section vibrato
 - 
 - Sinusoidal phase modulation.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item f
 - Modulation frequency in Hertz.
 - Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
 - 
 - @item d
 - Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
 - Default value is 0.5.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section volume
 - 
 - Adjust the input audio volume.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item volume
 - Set audio volume expression.
 - 
 - Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
 - 
 - The output audio volume is given by the relation:
 - @example
 - @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
 - @end example
 - 
 - The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
 - 
 - @item precision
 - This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
 - 
 - It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
 - precision of the volume scaling.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item fixed
 - 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
 - @item float
 - 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
 - @item double
 - 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item replaygain
 - Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item drop
 - Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
 - 
 - @item ignore
 - Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
 - 
 - @item track
 - Prefer the track gain, if present.
 - 
 - @item album
 - Prefer the album gain, if present.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item replaygain_preamp
 - Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
 - 
 - Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
 - 
 - @item eval
 - Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item once
 - only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
 - when the @samp{volume} command is sent
 - 
 - @item frame
 - evaluate expression for each incoming frame
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{once}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - frame number (starting at zero)
 - @item nb_channels
 - number of channels
 - @item nb_consumed_samples
 - number of samples consumed by the filter
 - @item nb_samples
 - number of samples in the current frame
 - @item pos
 - original frame position in the file
 - @item pts
 - frame PTS
 - @item sample_rate
 - sample rate
 - @item startpts
 - PTS at start of stream
 - @item startt
 - time at start of stream
 - @item t
 - frame time
 - @item tb
 - timestamp timebase
 - @item volume
 - last set volume value
 - @end table
 - 
 - Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
 - @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
 - variables will evaluate to NAN.
 - 
 - @subsection Commands
 - 
 - This filter supports the following commands:
 - @table @option
 - @item volume
 - Modify the volume expression.
 - The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
 - 
 - If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
 - value.
 - @item replaygain_noclip
 - Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
 - 
 - Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Halve the input audio volume:
 - @example
 - volume=volume=0.5
 - volume=volume=1/2
 - volume=volume=-6.0206dB
 - @end example
 - 
 - In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
 - omitted, for example like in:
 - @example
 - volume=0.5
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
 - @example
 - volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
 - @example
 - volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section volumedetect
 - 
 - Detect the volume of the input video.
 - 
 - The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
 - the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
 - 
 - In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
 - volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
 - registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
 - the samples).
 - 
 - All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - Here is an excerpt of the output:
 - @example
 - [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
 - [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
 - [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
 - [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
 - [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
 - [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
 - [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
 - [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
 - [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
 - @end example
 - 
 - It means that:
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
 - @item
 - The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
 - @item
 - There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
 - raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
 - 
 - @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
 - 
 - @chapter Audio Sources
 - @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
 - 
 - Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
 - 
 - @section abuffer
 - 
 - Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
 - 
 - This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
 - through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item time_base
 - The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
 - either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
 - 
 - @item sample_rate
 - The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
 - 
 - @item sample_fmt
 - The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
 - Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
 - the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
 - 
 - @item channel_layout
 - The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
 - Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
 - @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
 - from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
 - 
 - @item channels
 - The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
 - If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
 - must be consistent.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @example
 - abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
 - @end example
 - 
 - will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
 - Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
 - 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
 - equivalent to:
 - @example
 - abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section aevalsrc
 - 
 - Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
 - 
 - This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
 - channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
 - audio signal.
 - 
 - This source accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item exprs
 - Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
 - @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
 - depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
 - specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
 - 
 - @item channel_layout, c
 - Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
 - must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
 - 
 - @item duration, d
 - Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
 - @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
 - for the accepted syntax.
 - Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
 - duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
 - complete frame.
 - 
 - If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
 - supposed to be generated forever.
 - 
 - @item nb_samples, n
 - Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
 - default to 1024.
 - 
 - @item sample_rate, s
 - Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
 - 
 - @item t
 - time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
 - 
 - @item s
 - sample rate
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Generate silence:
 - @example
 - aevalsrc=0
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
 - 8000 Hz:
 - @example
 - aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
 - Center + Back Center) explicitly:
 - @example
 - aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate white noise:
 - @example
 - aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
 - @example
 - aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
 - @example
 - aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section anullsrc
 - 
 - The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
 - as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
 - the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
 - synth filter).
 - 
 - This source accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item channel_layout, cl
 - 
 - Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
 - representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
 - is "stereo".
 - 
 - Check the channel_layout_map definition in
 - @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
 - channel layout values.
 - 
 - @item sample_rate, r
 - Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
 - 
 - @item nb_samples, n
 - Set the number of samples per requested frames.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
 - @example
 - anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
 - @example
 - anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
 - 
 - @section flite
 - 
 - Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
 - 
 - To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
 - @code{--enable-libflite}.
 - 
 - Note that the flite library is not thread-safe.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item list_voices
 - If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
 - immediately. Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @item nb_samples, n
 - Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
 - 
 - @item textfile
 - Set the filename containing the text to speak.
 - 
 - @item text
 - Set the text to speak.
 - 
 - @item voice, v
 - Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
 - @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
 - standard flite voice:
 - @example
 - flite=textfile=speech.txt
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
 - @example
 - flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Input text to ffmpeg:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
 - the @code{lavfi} device:
 - @example
 - ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - For more information about libflite, check:
 - @url{http://www.speech.cs.cmu.edu/flite/}
 - 
 - @section anoisesrc
 - 
 - Generate a noise audio signal.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item sample_rate, r
 - Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
 - 
 - @item amplitude, a
 - Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
 - is 1.0.
 - 
 - @item duration, d
 - Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
 - results in noise with an infinite length.
 - 
 - @item color, colour, c
 - Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, and brown.
 - Default color is white.
 - 
 - @item seed, s
 - Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
 - 
 - @item nb_samples, n
 - Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
 - @example
 - anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section sine
 - 
 - Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
 - 
 - The audio signal is bit-exact.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item frequency, f
 - Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
 - 
 - @item beep_factor, b
 - Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
 - the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
 - 
 - @item sample_rate, r
 - Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
 - 
 - @item duration, d
 - Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
 - 
 - @item samples_per_frame
 - Set the number of samples per output frame.
 - 
 - The expression can contain the following constants:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
 - 
 - @item pts
 - The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
 - expressed in @var{TB} units.
 - 
 - @item t
 - The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
 - 
 - @item TB
 - The timebase of the output audio frames.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is @code{1024}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
 - @example
 - sine
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
 - @example
 - sine=220:4:d=5
 - sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
 - sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
 - pattern:
 - @example
 - sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
 - 
 - @chapter Audio Sinks
 - @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
 - 
 - Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
 - 
 - @section abuffersink
 - 
 - Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
 - 
 - This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
 - through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
 - or the options system.
 - 
 - It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
 - defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
 - parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
 - @section anullsink
 - 
 - Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
 - mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
 - tools.
 - 
 - @c man end AUDIO SINKS
 - 
 - @chapter Video Filters
 - @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
 - 
 - When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
 - existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
 - The configure output will show the video filters included in your
 - build.
 - 
 - Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
 - 
 - @section alphaextract
 - 
 - Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
 - is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
 - 
 - @section alphamerge
 - 
 - Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
 - grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
 - @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
 - sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
 - channel.
 - 
 - For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
 - and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
 - @example
 - movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
 - @end example
 - 
 - Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
 - sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
 - input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
 - pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
 - overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
 - 
 - @section ass
 - 
 - Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
 - and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
 - Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
 - the @ref{subtitles} filter:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item shaping
 - Set the shaping engine
 - 
 - Available values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item auto
 - The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
 - @item simple
 - Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
 - @item complex
 - Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
 - @end table
 - 
 - The default is @code{auto}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section atadenoise
 - Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item 0a
 - Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
 - Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
 - 
 - @item 0b
 - Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
 - Valid range is 0 to 5.
 - 
 - @item 1a
 - Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
 - Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
 - 
 - @item 1b
 - Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
 - Valid range is 0 to 5.
 - 
 - @item 2a
 - Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
 - Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
 - 
 - @item 2b
 - Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
 - Valid range is 0 to 5.
 - 
 - Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
 - threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
 - 
 - @item s
 - Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 33. Must be odd
 - number in range [5, 129].
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section bbox
 - 
 - Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
 - luminance plane.
 - 
 - This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
 - luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
 - The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
 - log.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following option:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item min_val
 - Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section blackdetect
 - 
 - Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
 - useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
 - recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
 - duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
 - 
 - In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
 - least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item black_min_duration, d
 - Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
 - be a non-negative floating point number.
 - 
 - Default value is 2.0.
 - 
 - @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
 - Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
 - Express the minimum value for the ratio:
 - @example
 - @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
 - @end example
 - 
 - for which a picture is considered black.
 - Default value is 0.98.
 - 
 - @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
 - Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
 - 
 - The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
 - pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
 - the following equation:
 - @example
 - @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
 - @end example
 - 
 - @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
 - the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
 - formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
 - 
 - Default value is 0.10.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
 - value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
 - @example
 - blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section blackframe
 - 
 - Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
 - detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
 - the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
 - the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
 - 
 - In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
 - least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item amount
 - The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
 - @code{98}.
 - 
 - @item threshold, thresh
 - The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
 - @code{32}.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section blend, tblend
 - 
 - Blend two video frames into each other.
 - 
 - The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
 - stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
 - "bottom" layer.  Output terminates when shortest input terminates.
 - 
 - The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
 - from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
 - the new frame on top of the old frame.
 - 
 - A description of the accepted options follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item c0_mode
 - @item c1_mode
 - @item c2_mode
 - @item c3_mode
 - @item all_mode
 - Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
 - of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
 - 
 - Available values for component modes are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item addition
 - @item addition128
 - @item and
 - @item average
 - @item burn
 - @item darken
 - @item difference
 - @item difference128
 - @item divide
 - @item dodge
 - @item exclusion
 - @item glow
 - @item hardlight
 - @item hardmix
 - @item lighten
 - @item linearlight
 - @item multiply
 - @item negation
 - @item normal
 - @item or
 - @item overlay
 - @item phoenix
 - @item pinlight
 - @item reflect
 - @item screen
 - @item softlight
 - @item subtract
 - @item vividlight
 - @item xor
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item c0_opacity
 - @item c1_opacity
 - @item c2_opacity
 - @item c3_opacity
 - @item all_opacity
 - Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
 - of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
 - 
 - @item c0_expr
 - @item c1_expr
 - @item c2_expr
 - @item c3_expr
 - @item all_expr
 - Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
 - of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
 - 
 - The expressions can use the following variables:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item N
 - The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item X
 - @item Y
 - the coordinates of the current sample
 - 
 - @item W
 - @item H
 - the width and height of currently filtered plane
 - 
 - @item SW
 - @item SH
 - Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
 - ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
 - plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
 - @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
 - 
 - @item T
 - Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
 - 
 - @item TOP, A
 - Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
 - 
 - @item BOTTOM, B
 - Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item shortest
 - Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is
 - @code{0}. This option is only defined for the @code{blend} filter.
 - 
 - @item repeatlast
 - Continue applying the last bottom frame after the end of the stream. A value of
 - @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the bottom layer is reached.
 - Default is @code{1}. This option is only defined for the @code{blend} filter.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
 - @example
 - blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
 - @example
 - blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply uncover left effect:
 - @example
 - blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply uncover down effect:
 - @example
 - blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply uncover up-left effect:
 - @example
 - blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
 - @example
 - tblend=all_mode=difference128
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section boxblur
 - 
 - Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item luma_radius, lr
 - @item luma_power, lp
 - @item chroma_radius, cr
 - @item chroma_power, cp
 - @item alpha_radius, ar
 - @item alpha_power, ap
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - A description of the accepted options follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item luma_radius, lr
 - @item chroma_radius, cr
 - @item alpha_radius, ar
 - Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
 - corresponding input plane.
 - 
 - The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
 - greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
 - luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
 - planes.
 - 
 - Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
 - @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
 - corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
 - 
 - The expressions can contain the following constants:
 - @table @option
 - @item w
 - @item h
 - The input width and height in pixels.
 - 
 - @item cw
 - @item ch
 - The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
 - 
 - @item hsub
 - @item vsub
 - The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item luma_power, lp
 - @item chroma_power, cp
 - @item alpha_power, ap
 - Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
 - corresponding plane.
 - 
 - Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
 - @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
 - corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
 - 
 - A value of 0 will disable the effect.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
 - set to 2:
 - @example
 - boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
 - boxblur=2:1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
 - @example
 - boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
 - @example
 - boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section chromakey
 - YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item color
 - The color which will be replaced with transparency.
 - 
 - @item similarity
 - Similarity percentage with the key color.
 - 
 - 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
 - 
 - @item blend
 - Blend percentage.
 - 
 - 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
 - 
 - Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
 - the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
 - 
 - @item yuv
 - Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
 - 
 - Litteral colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
 - This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section codecview
 - 
 - Visualize information exported by some codecs.
 - 
 - Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
 - means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
 - @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following option:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item mv
 - Set motion vectors to visualize.
 - 
 - Available flags for @var{mv} are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item pf
 - forward predicted MVs of P-frames
 - @item bf
 - forward predicted MVs of B-frames
 - @item bb
 - backward predicted MVs of B-frames
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item qp
 - Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Visualizes multi-directionals MVs from P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
 - @example
 - ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mpg -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section colorbalance
 - Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
 - 
 - The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
 - regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
 - 
 - A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
 - value towards the complementary color.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item rs
 - @item gs
 - @item bs
 - Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
 - 
 - @item rm
 - @item gm
 - @item bm
 - Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
 - 
 - @item rh
 - @item gh
 - @item bh
 - Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
 - 
 - Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Add red color cast to shadows:
 - @example
 - colorbalance=rs=.3
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section colorkey
 - RGB colorspace color keying.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item color
 - The color which will be replaced with transparency.
 - 
 - @item similarity
 - Similarity percentage with the key color.
 - 
 - 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
 - 
 - @item blend
 - Blend percentage.
 - 
 - 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
 - 
 - Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
 - the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section colorlevels
 - 
 - Adjust video input frames using levels.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item rimin
 - @item gimin
 - @item bimin
 - @item aimin
 - Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
 - Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item rimax
 - @item gimax
 - @item bimax
 - @item aimax
 - Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
 - Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
 - 
 - Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
 - (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
 - 
 - @item romin
 - @item gomin
 - @item bomin
 - @item aomin
 - Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
 - Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item romax
 - @item gomax
 - @item bomax
 - @item aomax
 - Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
 - Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
 - 
 - Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Make video output darker:
 - @example
 - colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Increase contrast:
 - @example
 - colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Make video output lighter:
 - @example
 - colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Increase brightness:
 - @example
 - colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section colorchannelmixer
 - 
 - Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
 - 
 - This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
 - the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
 - modify is red, the output value will be:
 - @example
 - @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
 - @end example
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item rr
 - @item rg
 - @item rb
 - @item ra
 - Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
 - Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
 - 
 - @item gr
 - @item gg
 - @item gb
 - @item ga
 - Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
 - Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
 - 
 - @item br
 - @item bg
 - @item bb
 - @item ba
 - Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
 - Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
 - 
 - @item ar
 - @item ag
 - @item ab
 - @item aa
 - Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
 - Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
 - 
 - Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Convert source to grayscale:
 - @example
 - colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
 - @end example
 - @item
 - Simulate sepia tones:
 - @example
 - colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section colormatrix
 - 
 - Convert color matrix.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item src
 - @item dst
 - Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
 - specified.
 - 
 - The accepted values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item bt709
 - BT.709
 - 
 - @item bt601
 - BT.601
 - 
 - @item smpte240m
 - SMPTE-240M
 - 
 - @item fcc
 - FCC
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
 - @example
 - colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section copy
 - 
 - Copy the input source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
 - testing purposes.
 - 
 - @section crop
 - 
 - Crop the input video to given dimensions.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item w, out_w
 - The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
 - This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
 - configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
 - 
 - @item h, out_h
 - The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
 - This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
 - configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
 - 
 - @item x
 - The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
 - video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
 - This expression is evaluated per-frame.
 - 
 - @item y
 - The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
 - It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
 - This expression is evaluated per-frame.
 - 
 - @item keep_aspect
 - If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
 - to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
 - ratio. It defaults to 0.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
 - expressions containing the following constants:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
 - each new frame.
 - 
 - @item in_w
 - @item in_h
 - The input width and height.
 - 
 - @item iw
 - @item ih
 - These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
 - 
 - @item out_w
 - @item out_h
 - The output (cropped) width and height.
 - 
 - @item ow
 - @item oh
 - These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
 - 
 - @item a
 - same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
 - 
 - @item sar
 - input sample aspect ratio
 - 
 - @item dar
 - input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
 - 
 - @item hsub
 - @item vsub
 - horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - 
 - @item n
 - The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
 - 
 - @item pos
 - the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
 - 
 - @item t
 - The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
 - and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
 - cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
 - evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
 - 
 - The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
 - position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
 - are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
 - is approximated to the nearest valid value.
 - 
 - The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
 - for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
 - @example
 - crop=100:100:12:34
 - @end example
 - 
 - Using named options, the example above becomes:
 - @example
 - crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
 - @example
 - crop=100:100
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
 - @example
 - crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Crop the input video central square:
 - @example
 - crop=out_w=in_h
 - crop=in_h
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
 - 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
 - corner of the input image.
 - @example
 - crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
 - the top and bottom borders
 - @example
 - crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
 - @example
 - crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
 - @example
 - crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply trembling effect:
 - @example
 - crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
 - @example
 - crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Set x depending on the value of y:
 - @example
 - crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @subsection Commands
 - 
 - This filter supports the following commands:
 - @table @option
 - @item w, out_w
 - @item h, out_h
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
 - in the input video.
 - The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
 - 
 - If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
 - value.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section cropdetect
 - 
 - Auto-detect the crop size.
 - 
 - It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
 - recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
 - correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item limit
 - Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
 - from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8bit based formats). An intensity
 - value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
 - You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
 - on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
 - 
 - @item round
 - The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
 - 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
 - get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
 - encoding to most video codecs.
 - 
 - @item reset_count, reset
 - Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
 - reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
 - detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
 - 
 - This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
 - indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
 - playback.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{curves}
 - @section curves
 - 
 - Apply color adjustments using curves.
 - 
 - This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
 - component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
 - tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
 - values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
 - the output frame.
 - 
 - By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
 - @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
 - "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
 - 
 - The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
 - curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
 - smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
 - strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
 - be in the @var{[0;1]} interval.  If the computed curves happened to go outside
 - the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
 - 
 - If there is no key point defined in @code{x=0}, the filter will automatically
 - insert a @var{(0;0)} point. In the same way, if there is no key point defined
 - in @code{x=1}, the filter will automatically insert a @var{(1;1)} point.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item preset
 - Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
 - to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
 - options takes priority on the preset values.
 - Available presets are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item none
 - @item color_negative
 - @item cross_process
 - @item darker
 - @item increase_contrast
 - @item lighter
 - @item linear_contrast
 - @item medium_contrast
 - @item negative
 - @item strong_contrast
 - @item vintage
 - @end table
 - Default is @code{none}.
 - @item master, m
 - Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
 - is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
 - @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
 - post-processing LUT.
 - @item red, r
 - Set the key points for the red component.
 - @item green, g
 - Set the key points for the green component.
 - @item blue, b
 - Set the key points for the blue component.
 - @item all
 - Set the key points for all components (not including master).
 - Can be used in addition to the other key points component
 - options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
 - @option{all} setting.
 - @item psfile
 - Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
 - @end table
 - 
 - To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
 - defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
 - @example
 - curves=blue='0.5/0.58'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Vintage effect:
 - @example
 - curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0.50/0.48':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
 - @end example
 - Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
 - @table @var
 - @item red
 - @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
 - @item green
 - @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
 - @item blue
 - @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item
 - The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
 - @example
 - curves=preset=vintage
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Or simply:
 - @example
 - curves=vintage
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
 - @example
 - curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0.45/0.53'
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section dctdnoiz
 - 
 - Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
 - 
 - This filter is not designed for real time.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item sigma, s
 - Set the noise sigma constant.
 - 
 - This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
 - coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
 - 
 - If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
 - 
 - Default is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item overlap
 - Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
 - may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
 - risk of various artefacts.
 - 
 - If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
 - height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
 - 
 - Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
 - 
 - @item expr, e
 - Set the coefficient factor expression.
 - 
 - For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
 - multiplier value for the coefficient.
 - 
 - If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
 - 
 - The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
 - variable.
 - 
 - @item n
 - Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
 - @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
 - 
 - The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
 - @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
 - on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
 - better de-noising.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
 - @example
 - dctdnoiz=4.5
 - @end example
 - 
 - The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
 - @example
 - dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
 - @example
 - dctdnoiz=15:n=4
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section deband
 - 
 - Remove banding artifacts from input video.
 - It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item 1thr
 - @item 2thr
 - @item 3thr
 - @item 4thr
 - Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
 - Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
 - If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
 - it will be considered as banded.
 - 
 - @item range, r
 - Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
 - in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
 - will be used.
 - The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
 - 
 - @item direction, d
 - Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
 - random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
 - absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
 - will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
 - column.
 - 
 - @item blur
 - If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
 - surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
 - compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
 - if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{decimate}
 - @section decimate
 - 
 - Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item cycle
 - Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
 - @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
 - Default is @code{5}.
 - 
 - @item dupthresh
 - Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
 - is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
 - is @code{1.1}
 - 
 - @item scthresh
 - Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
 - 
 - @item blockx
 - @item blocky
 - Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
 - Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
 - small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
 - 
 - @item ppsrc
 - Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
 - stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
 - the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
 - @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
 - stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
 - @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item chroma
 - Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
 - @code{1}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section deflate
 - 
 - Apply deflate effect to the video.
 - 
 - This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
 - only values lower than the pixel.
 - 
 - It accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item threshold0
 - @item threshold1
 - @item threshold2
 - @item threshold3
 - Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
 - If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section dejudder
 - 
 - Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
 - 
 - Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
 - source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
 - will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
 - container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
 - rate video.
 - 
 - The option available in this filter is:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item cycle
 - Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
 - 
 - Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
 - @table @samp
 - 
 - @item 4
 - If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
 - 
 - @item 5
 - If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
 - 
 - @item 20
 - If a mixture of the two.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The default is @samp{4}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section delogo
 - 
 - Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
 - pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
 - (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
 - specified.
 - 
 - @item w
 - @item h
 - Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
 - specified.
 - 
 - @item band, t
 - Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
 - @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
 - deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
 - is not recommended.
 - 
 - @item show
 - When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
 - finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
 - The default value is 0.
 - 
 - The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
 - replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
 - immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
 - compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
 - and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
 - @example
 - delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section deshake
 - 
 - Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
 - filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
 - tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - @item w
 - @item h
 - Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
 - vectors.
 - If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
 - rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
 - and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
 - filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
 - box.
 - 
 - This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
 - might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
 - 
 - If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
 - then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
 - without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
 - 
 - Default - search the whole frame.
 - 
 - @item rx
 - @item ry
 - Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
 - range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
 - 
 - @item edge
 - Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
 - frame. Available values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item blank, 0
 - Fill zeroes at blank locations
 - @item original, 1
 - Original image at blank locations
 - @item clamp, 2
 - Extruded edge value at blank locations
 - @item mirror, 3
 - Mirrored edge at blank locations
 - @end table
 - Default value is @samp{mirror}.
 - 
 - @item blocksize
 - Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
 - default 8.
 - 
 - @item contrast
 - Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
 - the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
 - pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
 - 
 - @item search
 - Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item exhaustive, 0
 - Set exhaustive search
 - @item less, 1
 - Set less exhaustive search.
 - @end table
 - Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
 - 
 - @item filename
 - If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
 - specified file.
 - 
 - @item opencl
 - If set to 1, specify using OpenCL capabilities, only available if
 - FFmpeg was configured with @code{--enable-opencl}. Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section detelecine
 - 
 - Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
 - pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
 - to the telecine filter.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item first_field
 - @table @samp
 - @item top, t
 - top field first
 - @item bottom, b
 - bottom field first
 - The default value is @code{top}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item pattern
 - A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
 - The default value is @code{23}.
 - 
 - @item start_frame
 - A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
 - pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section dilation
 - 
 - Apply dilation effect to the video.
 - 
 - This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
 - 
 - It accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item threshold0
 - @item threshold1
 - @item threshold2
 - @item threshold3
 - Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
 - If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
 - 
 - @item coordinates
 - Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
 - pixels are used.
 - 
 - Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
 - 
 -     1 2 3
 -     4   5
 -     6 7 8
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section displace
 - 
 - Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
 - 
 - It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
 - source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
 - 
 - The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
 - x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
 - along the y-axis.
 - If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
 - displacement map will be used.
 - 
 - Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
 - 
 - A description of the accepted options follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item edge
 - Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
 - 
 - Available values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item blank
 - Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
 - 
 - @item smear
 - Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
 - 
 - @item wrap
 - Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
 - @end table
 - Default is @samp{smear}.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section drawbox
 - 
 - Draw a colored box on the input image.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
 - 
 - @item width, w
 - @item height, h
 - The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
 - the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
 - 
 - @item color, c
 - Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
 - check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special
 - value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
 - video with inverted luma.
 - 
 - @item thickness, t
 - The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge. Default value is @code{3}.
 - 
 - See below for the list of accepted constants.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
 - following constants:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item dar
 - The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
 - 
 - @item hsub
 - @item vsub
 - horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - 
 - @item in_h, ih
 - @item in_w, iw
 - The input width and height.
 - 
 - @item sar
 - The input sample aspect ratio.
 - 
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
 - 
 - @item w
 - @item h
 - The width and height of the drawn box.
 - 
 - @item t
 - The thickness of the drawn box.
 - 
 - These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
 - each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
 - @example
 - drawbox
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
 - @example
 - drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
 - @end example
 - 
 - The previous example can be specified as:
 - @example
 - drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Fill the box with pink color:
 - @example
 - drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=max
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
 - @example
 - drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section drawgraph, adrawgraph
 - 
 - Draw a graph using input video or audio metadata.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item m1
 - Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
 - 
 - @item fg1
 - Set 1st foreground color expression.
 - 
 - @item m2
 - Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
 - 
 - @item fg2
 - Set 2nd foreground color expression.
 - 
 - @item m3
 - Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
 - 
 - @item fg3
 - Set 3rd foreground color expression.
 - 
 - @item m4
 - Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
 - 
 - @item fg4
 - Set 4th foreground color expression.
 - 
 - @item min
 - Set minimal value of metadata value.
 - 
 - @item max
 - Set maximal value of metadata value.
 - 
 - @item bg
 - Set graph background color. Default is white.
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Set graph mode.
 - 
 - Available values for mode is:
 - @table @samp
 - @item bar
 - @item dot
 - @item line
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is @code{line}.
 - 
 - @item slide
 - Set slide mode.
 - 
 - Available values for slide is:
 - @table @samp
 - @item frame
 - Draw new frame when right border is reached.
 - 
 - @item replace
 - Replace old columns with new ones.
 - 
 - @item scroll
 - Scroll from right to left.
 - 
 - @item rscroll
 - Scroll from left to right.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is @code{frame}.
 - 
 - @item size
 - Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - The default value is @code{900x256}.
 - 
 - The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
 - @table @option
 - @item MIN
 - Minimal value of metadata value.
 - 
 - @item MAX
 - Maximal value of metadata value.
 - 
 - @item VAL
 - Current metadata key value.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
 - @example
 - signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
 - @end example
 - 
 - Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
 - @example
 - ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section drawgrid
 - 
 - Draw a grid on the input image.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
 - 
 - @item width, w
 - @item height, h
 - The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
 - input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
 - framed. Default to 0.
 - 
 - @item color, c
 - Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
 - check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special
 - value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
 - video with inverted luma.
 - 
 - @item thickness, t
 - The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
 - 
 - See below for the list of accepted constants.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
 - following constants:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item dar
 - The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
 - 
 - @item hsub
 - @item vsub
 - horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - 
 - @item in_h, ih
 - @item in_w, iw
 - The input grid cell width and height.
 - 
 - @item sar
 - The input sample aspect ratio.
 - 
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
 - 
 - @item w
 - @item h
 - The width and height of the drawn cell.
 - 
 - @item t
 - The thickness of the drawn cell.
 - 
 - These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
 - each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
 - @example
 - drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
 - @example
 - drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{drawtext}
 - @section drawtext
 - 
 - Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
 - libfreetype library.
 - 
 - To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
 - @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
 - To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
 - configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
 - To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
 - @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
 - 
 - @subsection Syntax
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item box
 - Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
 - The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
 - The default value of @var{box} is 0.
 - 
 - @item boxborderw
 - Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
 - The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
 - 
 - @item boxcolor
 - The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
 - option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
 - 
 - The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
 - 
 - @item borderw
 - Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
 - The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
 - 
 - @item bordercolor
 - Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
 - option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
 - 
 - The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
 - 
 - @item expansion
 - Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
 - @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
 - @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
 - below for details.
 - 
 - @item fix_bounds
 - If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
 - 
 - @item fontcolor
 - The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
 - the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
 - 
 - The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
 - 
 - @item fontcolor_expr
 - String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
 - @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
 - processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
 - 
 - @item font
 - The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
 - 
 - @item fontfile
 - The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
 - This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
 - 
 - @item draw
 - This option does not exist, please see the timeline system
 - 
 - @item alpha
 - Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
 - be either a number between 0.0 and 1.0
 - The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} do.
 - The default value is 1.
 - Please see fontcolor_expr
 - 
 - @item fontsize
 - The font size to be used for drawing text.
 - The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
 - 
 - @item text_shaping
 - If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
 - right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
 - Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
 - By default 1 (if supported).
 - 
 - @item ft_load_flags
 - The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
 - 
 - The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
 - a combination of the following values:
 - @table @var
 - @item default
 - @item no_scale
 - @item no_hinting
 - @item render
 - @item no_bitmap
 - @item vertical_layout
 - @item force_autohint
 - @item crop_bitmap
 - @item pedantic
 - @item ignore_global_advance_width
 - @item no_recurse
 - @item ignore_transform
 - @item monochrome
 - @item linear_design
 - @item no_autohint
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is "default".
 - 
 - For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
 - libfreetype flags.
 - 
 - @item shadowcolor
 - The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
 - syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
 - 
 - The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
 - 
 - @item shadowx
 - @item shadowy
 - The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
 - position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
 - values. The default value for both is "0".
 - 
 - @item start_number
 - The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
 - is "0".
 - 
 - @item tabsize
 - The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
 - Default value is 4.
 - 
 - @item timecode
 - Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
 - format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
 - option must be specified.
 - 
 - @item timecode_rate, rate, r
 - Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only).
 - 
 - @item text
 - The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
 - encoded characters.
 - This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
 - @var{textfile}.
 - 
 - @item textfile
 - A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
 - of UTF-8 encoded characters.
 - 
 - This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
 - parameter @var{text}.
 - 
 - If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
 - 
 - @item reload
 - If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
 - Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
 - 
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
 - within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
 - output image.
 - 
 - The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
 - 
 - See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
 - following constants and functions:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item dar
 - input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
 - 
 - @item hsub
 - @item vsub
 - horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - 
 - @item line_h, lh
 - the height of each text line
 - 
 - @item main_h, h, H
 - the input height
 - 
 - @item main_w, w, W
 - the input width
 - 
 - @item max_glyph_a, ascent
 - the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
 - coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
 - glyphs.
 - It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
 - upwards.
 - 
 - @item max_glyph_d, descent
 - the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
 - used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
 - This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
 - upwards.
 - 
 - @item max_glyph_h
 - maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
 - contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
 - @var{descent}.
 - 
 - @item max_glyph_w
 - maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
 - contained in the rendered text
 - 
 - @item n
 - the number of input frame, starting from 0
 - 
 - @item rand(min, max)
 - return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
 - 
 - @item sar
 - The input sample aspect ratio.
 - 
 - @item t
 - timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
 - 
 - @item text_h, th
 - the height of the rendered text
 - 
 - @item text_w, tw
 - the width of the rendered text
 - 
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
 - 
 - These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
 - each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
 - @subsection Text expansion
 - 
 - If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
 - the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
 - expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
 - feature is deprecated.
 - 
 - If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
 - 
 - If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
 - the following expansion mechanism is used.
 - 
 - The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
 - the second character.
 - 
 - Sequence of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
 - braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
 - If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
 - they should be escaped.
 - 
 - Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
 - @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
 - argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
 - that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
 - problems.
 - 
 - The following functions are available:
 - 
 - @table @command
 - 
 - @item expr, e
 - The expression evaluation result.
 - 
 - It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
 - which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
 - @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
 - example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
 - the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
 - value.
 - 
 - @item expr_int_format, eif
 - Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
 - 
 - The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
 - The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
 - @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
 - @code{printf} function.
 - The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
 - It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
 - 
 - @item gmtime
 - The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
 - It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
 - 
 - @item localtime
 - The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
 - It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
 - 
 - @item metadata
 - Frame metadata. It must take one argument specifying metadata key.
 - 
 - @item n, frame_num
 - The frame number, starting from 0.
 - 
 - @item pict_type
 - A 1 character description of the current picture type.
 - 
 - @item pts
 - The timestamp of the current frame.
 - It can take up to three arguments.
 - 
 - The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
 - for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
 - for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
 - @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
 - @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
 - local time zone time.
 - 
 - The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
 - 
 - If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
 - a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
 - By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
 - optional parameters.
 - 
 - @example
 - drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
 - and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
 - yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
 - opacity of 20%.
 - 
 - @example
 - drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
 -           x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
 - @end example
 - 
 - Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
 - within the parameter list.
 - 
 - @item
 - Show the text at the center of the video frame:
 - @example
 - drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
 - frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
 - with no newlines.
 - @example
 - drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
 - @example
 - drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
 - The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
 - @example
 - drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
 - @example
 - drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
 - @example
 - drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
 - @example
 - drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
 - @example
 - #!/bin/sh
 - DS=1.0 # display start
 - DE=10.0 # display end
 - FID=1.5 # fade in duration
 - FOD=5 # fade out duration
 - ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - For more information about libfreetype, check:
 - @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
 - 
 - For more information about fontconfig, check:
 - @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
 - 
 - For more information about libfribidi, check:
 - @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
 - 
 - @section edgedetect
 - 
 - Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item low
 - @item high
 - Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
 - algorithm.
 - 
 - The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
 - connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
 - by the low threshold.
 - 
 - @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
 - [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
 - 
 - Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
 - is @code{50/255}.
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Define the drawing mode.
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item wires
 - Draw white/gray wires on black background.
 - 
 - @item colormix
 - Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @var{wires}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
 - @example
 - edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Painting effect without thresholding:
 - @example
 - edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section eq
 - Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item contrast
 - Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
 - @code{-2.0} to @code{2.0}. The default value is "1".
 - 
 - @item brightness
 - Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
 - range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
 - 
 - @item saturation
 - Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
 - range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
 - 
 - @item gamma
 - Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
 - @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}.  The default value is "1".
 - 
 - @item gamma_r
 - Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
 - range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
 - 
 - @item gamma_g
 - Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
 - @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
 - 
 - @item gamma_b
 - Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
 - @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
 - 
 - @item gamma_weight
 - Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
 - of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
 - getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
 - in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
 - gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
 - full strength. Default is "1".
 - 
 - @item eval
 - Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
 - gamma expressions are evaluated.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item init
 - only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
 - when a command is processed
 - 
 - @item frame
 - evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{init}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The expressions accept the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - frame count of the input frame starting from 0
 - 
 - @item pos
 - byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
 - unspecified
 - 
 - @item r
 - frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
 - 
 - @item t
 - timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Commands
 - The filter supports the following commands:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item contrast
 - Set the contrast expression.
 - 
 - @item brightness
 - Set the brightness expression.
 - 
 - @item saturation
 - Set the saturation expression.
 - 
 - @item gamma
 - Set the gamma expression.
 - 
 - @item gamma_r
 - Set the gamma_r expression.
 - 
 - @item gamma_g
 - Set gamma_g expression.
 - 
 - @item gamma_b
 - Set gamma_b expression.
 - 
 - @item gamma_weight
 - Set gamma_weight expression.
 - 
 - The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
 - 
 - If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
 - value.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section erosion
 - 
 - Apply erosion effect to the video.
 - 
 - This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
 - 
 - It accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item threshold0
 - @item threshold1
 - @item threshold2
 - @item threshold3
 - Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
 - If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
 - 
 - @item coordinates
 - Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
 - pixels are used.
 - 
 - Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
 - 
 -     1 2 3
 -     4   5
 -     6 7 8
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section extractplanes
 - 
 - Extract color channel components from input video stream into
 - separate grayscale video streams.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following option:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item planes
 - Set plane(s) to extract.
 - 
 - Available values for planes are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item y
 - @item u
 - @item v
 - @item a
 - @item r
 - @item g
 - @item b
 - @end table
 - 
 - Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
 - That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
 - with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
 - into 3 grayscale outputs:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section elbg
 - 
 - Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
 - 
 - For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
 - the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
 - of distinct output colors.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following options.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item codebook_length, l
 - Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
 - represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
 - 
 - @item nb_steps, n
 - Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
 - mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
 - computation time. Default value is 1.
 - 
 - @item seed, s
 - Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
 - UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
 - will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
 - 
 - @item pal8
 - Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
 - length greater than 256.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section fade
 - 
 - Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item type, t
 - The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
 - effect.
 - Default is @code{in}.
 - 
 - @item start_frame, s
 - Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
 - effect at. Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item nb_frames, n
 - The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
 - fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
 - At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
 - selected @option{color}.
 - Default is 25.
 - 
 - @item alpha
 - If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
 - Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @item start_time, st
 - Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
 - effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
 - whichever comes last.  Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item duration, d
 - The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
 - fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
 - at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
 - selected @option{color}.
 - If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
 - (nb_frames is used by default).
 - 
 - @item color, c
 - Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
 - @example
 - fade=in:0:30
 - @end example
 - 
 - The command above is equivalent to:
 - @example
 - fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
 - @example
 - fade=out:155:45
 - fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
 - @example
 - fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
 - @example
 - fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
 - @example
 - fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
 - @example
 - fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section fftfilt
 - Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item dc_Y
 - Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
 - accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
 - value is set to @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item dc_U
 - Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
 - filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
 - default value is set to @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item dc_V
 - Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
 - filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
 - default value is set to @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item weight_Y
 - Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
 - 
 - @item weight_U
 - Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
 - 
 - @item weight_V
 - Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following variables:
 - @item X
 - @item Y
 - The coordinates of the current sample.
 - 
 - @item W
 - @item H
 - The width and height of the image.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - High-pass:
 - @example
 - fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Low-pass:
 - @example
 - fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Sharpen:
 - @example
 - fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section field
 - 
 - Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
 - arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
 - non-interlaced.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item type
 - Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
 - @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
 - @code{bottom}).
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section fieldmatch
 - 
 - Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
 - progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
 - frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
 - followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
 - 
 - The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
 - the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
 - If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
 - @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
 - But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
 - de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
 - 
 - In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
 - optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
 - enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
 - this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
 - help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
 - (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
 - or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
 - 
 - Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
 - and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
 - which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
 - close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
 - 
 - The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
 - If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
 - framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
 - stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item order
 - Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item auto
 - Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
 - @item bff
 - Assume bottom field first.
 - @item tff
 - Assume top field first.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
 - stream.
 - 
 - Default value is @var{auto}.
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
 - sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
 - possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
 - outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
 - hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
 - but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
 - all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
 - jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
 - with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
 - 
 - More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
 - 
 - Available values are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item pc
 - 2-way matching (p/c)
 - @item pc_n
 - 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
 - @item pc_u
 - 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
 - @item pc_n_ub
 - 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
 - still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
 - @item pcn
 - 3-way matching (p/c/n)
 - @item pcn_ub
 - 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
 - detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
 - @end table
 - 
 - The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
 - mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
 - @var{top}).
 - 
 - In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
 - the slowest.
 - 
 - Default value is @var{pc_n}.
 - 
 - @item ppsrc
 - Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
 - input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
 - introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
 - VFM/TFM.
 - 
 - Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
 - 
 - @item field
 - Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
 - @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
 - certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
 - large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item auto
 - Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
 - @item bottom
 - Match from the bottom field.
 - @item top
 - Match from the top field.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @var{auto}.
 - 
 - @item mchroma
 - Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
 - cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
 - only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
 - artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
 - the cost of some accuracy.
 - 
 - Default value is @code{1}.
 - 
 - @item y0
 - @item y1
 - These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
 - @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
 - band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
 - interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
 - @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
 - @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
 - @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
 - @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item scthresh
 - Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
 - the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
 - detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}.  The range for
 - @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
 - 
 - Default value is @code{12.0}.
 - 
 - @item combmatch
 - When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
 - account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
 - final match. Available values are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item none
 - No final matching based on combed scores.
 - @item sc
 - Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
 - @item full
 - Use combed scores all the time.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is @var{sc}.
 - 
 - @item combdbg
 - Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
 - print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
 - Available values are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item none
 - No forced calculation.
 - @item pcn
 - Force p/c/n calculations.
 - @item pcnub
 - Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @var{none}.
 - 
 - @item cthresh
 - This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
 - essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
 - Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
 - can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
 - @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
 - be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
 - range is @code{[8, 12]}.
 - 
 - Default value is @code{9}.
 - 
 - @item chroma
 - Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision.  Only
 - disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
 - causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
 - using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
 - where there is chroma only combing in the source.
 - 
 - Default value is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item blockx
 - @item blocky
 - Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
 - frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
 - @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
 - declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
 - Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
 - to 512.
 - 
 - Default value is @code{16}.
 - 
 - @item combpel
 - The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
 - @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
 - combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
 - setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
 - window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
 - frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
 - which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
 - as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
 - 
 - Default value is @code{80}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
 - @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
 - 
 - @subsubsection p/c/n
 - 
 - We assume the following telecined stream:
 - 
 - @example
 - Top fields:     1 2 2 3 4
 - Bottom fields:  1 2 3 4 4
 - @end example
 - 
 - The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
 - first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
 - 
 - When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
 - (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
 - 
 - @example
 - Input stream:
 -                 T     1 2 2 3 4
 -                 B     1 2 3 4 4   <-- matching reference
 - 
 - Matches:              c c n n c
 - 
 - Output stream:
 -                 T     1 2 3 4 4
 -                 B     1 2 3 4 4
 - @end example
 - 
 - As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
 - To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
 - after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
 - 
 - The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
 - looks like this:
 - 
 - @example
 - Input stream:
 -                 T     1 2 2 3 4   <-- matching reference
 -                 B     1 2 3 4 4
 - 
 - Matches:              c c p p c
 - 
 - Output stream:
 -                 T     1 2 2 3 4
 -                 B     1 2 2 3 4
 - @end example
 - 
 - In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
 - basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
 - @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
 - @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @subsubsection u/b
 - 
 - The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
 - from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
 - currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
 - 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
 - 
 - With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
 - @example
 - Match:           c         p           n          b          u
 - 
 -                  x       x               x        x          x
 -   Top          1 2 2     1 2 2       1 2 2      1 2 2      1 2 2
 -   Bottom       1 2 3     1 2 3       1 2 3      1 2 3      1 2 3
 -                  x         x           x        x              x
 - 
 - Output frames:
 -                  2          1          2          2          2
 -                  2          2          2          1          3
 - @end example
 - 
 - With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
 - @example
 - Match:           c         p           n          b          u
 - 
 -                  x         x           x        x              x
 -   Top          1 2 2     1 2 2       1 2 2      1 2 2      1 2 2
 -   Bottom       1 2 3     1 2 3       1 2 3      1 2 3      1 2 3
 -                  x       x               x        x          x
 - 
 - Output frames:
 -                  2          2          2          1          2
 -                  2          1          3          2          2
 - @end example
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
 - @example
 - fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
 - @end example
 - 
 - Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
 - @example
 - fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section fieldorder
 - 
 - Transform the field order of the input video.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item order
 - The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
 - for bottom field first.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The default value is @samp{tff}.
 - 
 - The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
 - by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
 - This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
 - 
 - If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
 - flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
 - not alter the incoming video.
 - 
 - It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
 - which is bottom field first.
 - 
 - For example:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section fifo, afifo
 - 
 - Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
 - 
 - It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
 - framework.
 - 
 - It does not take parameters.
 - 
 - @section find_rect
 - 
 - Find a rectangular object
 - 
 - It accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item object
 - Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
 - 
 - @item threshold
 - Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
 - 
 - @item mipmaps
 - Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
 - 
 - @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
 - Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section cover_rect
 - 
 - Cover a rectangular object
 - 
 - It accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item cover
 - Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Set covering mode.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item cover
 - cover it by the supplied image
 - @item blur
 - cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @var{blur}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{format}
 - @section format
 - 
 - Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
 - Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
 - the next filter.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item pix_fmts
 - A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
 - "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
 - @example
 - format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
 - @end example
 - 
 - Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
 - @example
 - format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{fps}
 - @section fps
 - 
 - Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
 - frames as necessary.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item fps
 - The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
 - 
 - @item round
 - Rounding method.
 - 
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @option
 - @item zero
 - zero round towards 0
 - @item inf
 - round away from 0
 - @item down
 - round towards -infinity
 - @item up
 - round towards +infinity
 - @item near
 - round to nearest
 - @end table
 - The default is @code{near}.
 - 
 - @item start_time
 - Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
 - padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
 - about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
 - For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
 - the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
 - frames with a negative PTS.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
 - @var{fps}[:@var{round}].
 - 
 - See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
 - @example
 - fps=fps=25
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
 - @example
 - fps=fps=film:round=near
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section framepack
 - 
 - Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
 - metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
 - framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
 - that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
 - @ref{fps} filters.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item format
 - The desired packing format. Supported values are:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item sbs
 - The views are next to each other (default).
 - 
 - @item tab
 - The views are on top of each other.
 - 
 - @item lines
 - The views are packed by line.
 - 
 - @item columns
 - The views are packed by column.
 - 
 - @item frameseq
 - The views are temporally interleaved.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - Some examples:
 - 
 - @example
 - # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
 - ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
 - 
 - # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
 - ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section framerate
 - 
 - Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
 - frames.
 - 
 - This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
 - you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
 - to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
 - 
 - A description of the accepted options follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item fps
 - Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
 - as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
 - 
 - @item interp_start
 - Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
 - linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
 - the default is @code{15}.
 - 
 - @item interp_end
 - Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
 - linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
 - the default is @code{240}.
 - 
 - @item scene
 - Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
 - 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
 - probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
 - value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
 - The default is @code{7}.
 - 
 - @item flags
 - Specify flags influencing the filter process.
 - 
 - Available value for @var{flags} is:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item scene_change_detect, scd
 - Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
 - This flag is enabled by default.
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section framestep
 - 
 - Select one frame every N-th frame.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following option:
 - @table @option
 - @item step
 - Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
 - Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{frei0r}
 - @section frei0r
 - 
 - Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
 - 
 - To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
 - header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item filter_name
 - The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
 - @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
 - directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREIOR_PATH}.
 - Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
 - @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
 - @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
 - 
 - @item filter_params
 - A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
 - "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
 - @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
 - numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or by a color description specified in the "Color"
 - section in the ffmpeg-utils manual), a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
 - @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
 - 
 - The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
 - effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
 - @example
 - frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
 - @example
 - frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
 - frei0r=colordistance:violet
 - frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
 - positions:
 - @example
 - frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - For more information, see
 - @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
 - 
 - @section fspp
 - 
 - Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
 - 
 - It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
 - processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
 - This allows for much higher speed.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item quality
 - Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
 - an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
 - 
 - @item qp
 - Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
 - If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
 - 
 - @item strength
 - Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
 - more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
 - but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
 - 
 - @item use_bframe_qp
 - Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
 - option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
 - @code{0} (not enabled).
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section geq
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item lum_expr, lum
 - Set the luminance expression.
 - @item cb_expr, cb
 - Set the chrominance blue expression.
 - @item cr_expr, cr
 - Set the chrominance red expression.
 - @item alpha_expr, a
 - Set the alpha expression.
 - @item red_expr, r
 - Set the red expression.
 - @item green_expr, g
 - Set the green expression.
 - @item blue_expr, b
 - Set the blue expression.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
 - of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
 - options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
 - colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
 - @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
 - colorspace.
 - 
 - If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
 - one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
 - If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
 - to the luminance expression.
 - 
 - The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item N
 - The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item X
 - @item Y
 - The coordinates of the current sample.
 - 
 - @item W
 - @item H
 - The width and height of the image.
 - 
 - @item SW
 - @item SH
 - Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
 - ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
 - plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
 - @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
 - 
 - @item T
 - Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
 - 
 - @item p(x, y)
 - Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
 - plane.
 - 
 - @item lum(x, y)
 - Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
 - plane.
 - 
 - @item cb(x, y)
 - Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
 - blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
 - 
 - @item cr(x, y)
 - Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
 - red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
 - 
 - @item r(x, y)
 - @item g(x, y)
 - @item b(x, y)
 - Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
 - red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
 - 
 - @item alpha(x, y)
 - Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
 - plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
 - @end table
 - 
 - For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
 - automatically clipped to the closer edge.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Flip the image horizontally:
 - @example
 - geq=p(W-X\,Y)
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
 - wavelength of 100 pixels:
 - @example
 - geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
 - @example
 - nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate a quick emboss effect:
 - @example
 - format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
 - @example
 - geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
 - the @ref{vignette} filter):
 - @example
 - geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Create a linear gradient to use as a mask for another filter, then
 - compose with @ref{overlay}. In this example the video will gradually
 - become more blurry from the top to the bottom of the y-axis as defined
 - by the linear gradient:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i input.mp4 -filter_complex "geq=lum=255*(Y/H),format=gray[grad];[0:v]boxblur=4[blur];[blur][grad]alphamerge[alpha];[0:v][alpha]overlay" output.mp4
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section gradfun
 - 
 - Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
 - regions by truncation to 8bit color depth.
 - Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
 - dither them.
 - 
 - It is designed for playback only.  Do not use it prior to
 - lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
 - bring back the bands.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item strength
 - The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
 - the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
 - .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
 - valid range.
 - 
 - @item radius
 - The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
 - gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
 - regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
 - values will be clipped to the valid range.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
 - @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
 - @example
 - gradfun=3.5:8
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
 - value):
 - @example
 - gradfun=radius=8
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{haldclut}
 - @section haldclut
 - 
 - Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
 - 
 - First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
 - The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item shortest
 - Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
 - @item repeatlast
 - Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
 - @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
 - Default is @code{1}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
 - filters share the same internals).
 - 
 - More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
 - (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
 - 
 - @subsection Workflow examples
 - 
 - @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
 - 
 - Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
 - @end example
 - 
 - Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
 - 
 - Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
 - @end example
 - 
 - The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
 - @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
 - to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
 - 
 - @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
 - 
 - A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
 - @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
 - biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
 - padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
 - a preview of the Hald CLUT.
 - 
 - Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
 - @code{haldclut} filter:
 - 
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
 -    pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
 -    smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
 -    [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
 -    [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
 - @end example
 - 
 - It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
 - bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
 - the color changes.
 - 
 - Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
 - @example
 - ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section hflip
 - 
 - Flip the input video horizontally.
 - 
 - For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section histeq
 - This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
 - per-frame basis.
 - 
 - It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
 - intensities.  The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
 - equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
 - viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
 - useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
 - video.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item strength
 - Determine the amount of equalization to be applied.  As the strength
 - is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
 - approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
 - in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
 - 
 - @item intensity
 - Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
 - values appropriately.  The strength should be set as desired and then
 - the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
 - must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
 - 
 - @item antibanding
 - Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
 - the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
 - the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
 - @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section histogram
 - 
 - Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
 - 
 - The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
 - distribution in an image.
 - 
 - Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
 - Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
 - the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
 - current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item level_height
 - Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
 - Allowed range is [50, 2048].
 - 
 - @item scale_height
 - Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
 - Allowed range is [0, 40].
 - 
 - @item display_mode
 - Set display mode.
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item parade
 - Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
 - 
 - @item overlay
 - Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
 - that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
 - over one another.
 - @end table
 - Default is @code{parade}.
 - 
 - @item levels_mode
 - Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
 - Default is @code{linear}.
 - 
 - @item components
 - Set what color components to display.
 - Default is @code{7}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - 
 - @item
 - Calculate and draw histogram:
 - @example
 - ffplay -i input -vf histogram
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{hqdn3d}
 - @section hqdn3d
 - 
 - This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
 - image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
 - still. It should enhance compressibility.
 - 
 - It accepts the following optional parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item luma_spatial
 - A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
 - It defaults to 4.0.
 - 
 - @item chroma_spatial
 - A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
 - It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
 - 
 - @item luma_tmp
 - A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
 - 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
 - 
 - @item chroma_tmp
 - A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
 - @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section hqx
 - 
 - Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
 - was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
 - 
 - It accepts the following option:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
 - @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
 - Default is @code{3}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section hstack
 - Stack input videos horizontally.
 - 
 - All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
 - 
 - Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
 - to create same output.
 - 
 - The filter accept the following option:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item inputs
 - Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
 - 
 - @item shortest
 - If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
 - terminates. Default value is 0.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section hue
 - 
 - Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item h
 - Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
 - and defaults to "0".
 - 
 - @item s
 - Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
 - defaults to "1".
 - 
 - @item H
 - Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
 - expression, and defaults to "0".
 - 
 - @item b
 - Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
 - defaults to "0".
 - @end table
 - 
 - @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
 - specified at the same time.
 - 
 - The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
 - expressions containing the following constants:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - frame count of the input frame starting from 0
 - 
 - @item pts
 - presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
 - 
 - @item r
 - frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
 - 
 - @item t
 - timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
 - 
 - @item tb
 - time base of the input video
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
 - @example
 - hue=h=90:s=1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
 - @example
 - hue=H=PI/2:s=1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
 - and 2 over a period of 1 second:
 - @example
 - hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
 - @example
 - hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
 - @end example
 - 
 - The general fade-in expression can be written as:
 - @example
 - hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
 - @example
 - hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
 - @end example
 - 
 - The general fade-out expression can be written as:
 - @example
 - hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @subsection Commands
 - 
 - This filter supports the following commands:
 - @table @option
 - @item b
 - @item s
 - @item h
 - @item H
 - Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
 - The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
 - 
 - If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
 - value.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section idet
 - 
 - Detect video interlacing type.
 - 
 - This filter tries to detect if the input frames as interlaced, progressive,
 - top or bottom field first. It will also try and detect fields that are
 - repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
 - 
 - Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
 - Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
 - 
 - The filter will log these metadata values:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item single.current_frame
 - Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
 - ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
 - ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
 - 
 - @item single.tff
 - Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
 - 
 - @item multiple.tff
 - Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
 - 
 - @item single.bff
 - Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
 - 
 - @item multiple.current_frame
 - Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
 - ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
 - ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
 - 
 - @item multiple.bff
 - Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
 - 
 - @item single.progressive
 - Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
 - 
 - @item multiple.progressive
 - Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
 - 
 - @item single.undetermined
 - Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
 - 
 - @item multiple.undetermined
 - Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
 - 
 - @item repeated.current_frame
 - Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
 - 
 - @item repeated.neither
 - Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
 - 
 - @item repeated.top
 - Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
 - 
 - @item repeated.bottom
 - Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item intl_thres
 - Set interlacing threshold.
 - @item prog_thres
 - Set progressive threshold.
 - @item repeat_thres
 - Threshold for repeated field detection.
 - @item half_life
 - Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
 - statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to it's
 - classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
 - full weight of 1.0 forever.
 - @item analyze_interlaced_flag
 - When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
 - if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
 - If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
 - computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
 - further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
 - method to clean up the interlaced flag
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section il
 - 
 - Deinterleave or interleave fields.
 - 
 - This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
 - deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
 - fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
 - half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
 - You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item luma_mode, l
 - @item chroma_mode, c
 - @item alpha_mode, a
 - Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
 - @var{alpha_mode} are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item none
 - Do nothing.
 - 
 - @item deinterleave, d
 - Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
 - 
 - @item interleave, i
 - Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
 - @end table
 - Default value is @code{none}.
 - 
 - @item luma_swap, ls
 - @item chroma_swap, cs
 - @item alpha_swap, as
 - Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section inflate
 - 
 - Apply inflate effect to the video.
 - 
 - This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
 - only values higher than the pixel.
 - 
 - It accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item threshold0
 - @item threshold1
 - @item threshold2
 - @item threshold3
 - Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
 - If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section interlace
 - 
 - Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
 - lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
 - halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
 - 
 - @example
 -    Original        Original             New Frame
 -    Frame 'j'      Frame 'j+1'             (tff)
 -   ==========      ===========       ==================
 -     Line 0  -------------------->    Frame 'j' Line 0
 -     Line 1          Line 1  ---->   Frame 'j+1' Line 1
 -     Line 2 --------------------->    Frame 'j' Line 2
 -     Line 3          Line 3  ---->   Frame 'j+1' Line 3
 -      ...             ...                   ...
 - New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
 - @end example
 - 
 - It accepts the following optional parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item scan
 - This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
 - (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
 - 
 - @item lowpass
 - Enable (default) or disable the vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter
 - interlacing and reduce moire patterns.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section kerndeint
 - 
 - Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
 - deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
 - progressive frames.
 - 
 - The description of the accepted parameters follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item thresh
 - Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
 - determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
 - in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
 - applying the process on every pixels.
 - 
 - @item map
 - Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
 - Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item order
 - Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
 - 0. Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item sharp
 - Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item twoway
 - Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Apply default values:
 - @example
 - kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Enable additional sharpening:
 - @example
 - kerndeint=sharp=1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Paint processed pixels in white:
 - @example
 - kerndeint=map=1
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section lenscorrection
 - 
 - Correct radial lens distortion
 - 
 - This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
 - of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
 - one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
 - To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
 - and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
 - 
 - Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
 - Digikam from the KDE project.
 - 
 - In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
 - this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
 - brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
 - cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
 - be applied before or after lens correction.
 - 
 - @subsection Options
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item cx
 - Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
 - distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
 - width.
 - @item cy
 - Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
 - distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
 - height.
 - @item k1
 - Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. 0.5 means no correction.
 - @item k2
 - Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. 0.5 means no correction.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The formula that generates the correction is:
 - 
 - @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
 - 
 - where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
 - distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
 - 
 - @anchor{lut3d}
 - @section lut3d
 - 
 - Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item file
 - Set the 3D LUT file name.
 - 
 - Currently supported formats:
 - @table @samp
 - @item 3dl
 - AfterEffects
 - @item cube
 - Iridas
 - @item dat
 - DaVinci
 - @item m3d
 - Pandora
 - @end table
 - @item interp
 - Select interpolation mode.
 - 
 - Available values are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item nearest
 - Use values from the nearest defined point.
 - @item trilinear
 - Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
 - @item tetrahedral
 - Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
 - 
 - Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
 - to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
 - 
 - @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
 - to an RGB input video.
 - 
 - These filters accept the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - @item c0
 - set first pixel component expression
 - @item c1
 - set second pixel component expression
 - @item c2
 - set third pixel component expression
 - @item c3
 - set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
 - 
 - @item r
 - set red component expression
 - @item g
 - set green component expression
 - @item b
 - set blue component expression
 - @item a
 - alpha component expression
 - 
 - @item y
 - set Y/luminance component expression
 - @item u
 - set U/Cb component expression
 - @item v
 - set V/Cr component expression
 - @end table
 - 
 - Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
 - the corresponding pixel component values.
 - 
 - The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
 - format in input.
 - 
 - The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
 - @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
 - 
 - The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item w
 - @item h
 - The input width and height.
 - 
 - @item val
 - The input value for the pixel component.
 - 
 - @item clipval
 - The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
 - 
 - @item maxval
 - The maximum value for the pixel component.
 - 
 - @item minval
 - The minimum value for the pixel component.
 - 
 - @item negval
 - The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
 - @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
 - "maxval-clipval+minval".
 - 
 - @item clip(val)
 - The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
 - @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
 - 
 - @item gammaval(gamma)
 - The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
 - clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
 - expression
 - "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - All expressions default to "val".
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Negate input video:
 - @example
 - lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
 - lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
 - @end example
 - 
 - The above is the same as:
 - @example
 - lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
 - lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Negate luminance:
 - @example
 - lutyuv=y=negval
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
 - @example
 - lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply a luma burning effect:
 - @example
 - lutyuv="y=2*val"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Remove green and blue components:
 - @example
 - lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
 - @example
 - format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
 - @example
 - lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Discard least significant bits of luma:
 - @example
 - lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section maskedmerge
 - 
 - Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
 - weights in the third input stream.
 - 
 - A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
 - from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
 - 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
 - unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
 - input stream's pixel components.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following options:
 - @table @option
 - @item planes
 - Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
 - copied from first stream.
 - By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section mcdeint
 - 
 - Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
 - 
 - It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
 - with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following options:
 - @table @option
 - @item mode
 - Set the deinterlacing mode.
 - 
 - It accepts one of the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item fast
 - @item medium
 - @item slow
 - use iterative motion estimation
 - @item extra_slow
 - like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
 - @end table
 - Default value is @samp{fast}.
 - 
 - @item parity
 - Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
 - one of the following values:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item 0, tff
 - assume top field first
 - @item 1, bff
 - assume bottom field first
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{bff}.
 - 
 - @item qp
 - Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
 - encoder.
 - 
 - Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
 - optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section mergeplanes
 - 
 - Merge color channel components from several video streams.
 - 
 - The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
 - planes to the output video.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following options:
 - @table @option
 - @item mapping
 - Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
 - 
 - The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
 - hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
 - mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
 - the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
 - corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
 - similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
 - plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
 - 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
 - 
 - @item format
 - Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
 - @example
 - [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
 - @example
 - [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
 - @example
 - format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
 - @example
 - format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
 - @example
 - format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section mpdecimate
 - 
 - Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
 - order to reduce frame rate.
 - 
 - The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
 - (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
 - fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
 - 
 - A description of the accepted options follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item max
 - Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
 - positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
 - negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped unregarding the
 - number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
 - 
 - Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @item hi
 - @item lo
 - @item frac
 - Set the dropping threshold values.
 - 
 - Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
 - represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
 - corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
 - out differently over the block.
 - 
 - A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
 - than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
 - meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
 - 
 - Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
 - 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
 - @end table
 - 
 - 
 - @section negate
 - 
 - Negate input video.
 - 
 - It accepts an integer in input; if non-zero it negates the
 - alpha component (if available). The default value in input is 0.
 - 
 - @section noformat
 - 
 - Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
 - input to the next filter.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item pix_fmts
 - A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
 - apix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
 - input to the vflip filter:
 - @example
 - noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
 - @example
 - noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section noise
 - 
 - Add noise on video input frame.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item all_seed
 - @item c0_seed
 - @item c1_seed
 - @item c2_seed
 - @item c3_seed
 - Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
 - of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
 - 
 - @item all_strength, alls
 - @item c0_strength, c0s
 - @item c1_strength, c1s
 - @item c2_strength, c2s
 - @item c3_strength, c3s
 - Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
 - @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
 - 
 - @item all_flags, allf
 - @item c0_flags, c0f
 - @item c1_flags, c1f
 - @item c2_flags, c2f
 - @item c3_flags, c3f
 - Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
 - Available values for component flags are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item a
 - averaged temporal noise (smoother)
 - @item p
 - mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
 - @item t
 - temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
 - @item u
 - uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
 - @example
 - noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section null
 - 
 - Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
 - 
 - @section ocr
 - Optical Character Recognition
 - 
 - This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition.
 - 
 - It accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item datapath
 - Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
 - set at installation.
 - 
 - @item language
 - Set language, default is "eng".
 - 
 - @item whitelist
 - Set character whitelist.
 - 
 - @item blacklist
 - Set character blacklist.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
 - 
 - @section ocv
 - 
 - Apply a video transform using libopencv.
 - 
 - To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
 - configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item filter_name
 - The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
 - 
 - @item filter_params
 - The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
 - values are assumed.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
 - information:
 - @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
 - 
 - Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
 - 
 - @anchor{dilate}
 - @subsection dilate
 - 
 - Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
 - It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
 - 
 - It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
 - 
 - @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
 - @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
 - 
 - @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
 - the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
 - point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
 - must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
 - 
 - If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
 - string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
 - @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
 - printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
 - @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
 - or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
 - 
 - The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
 - 
 - @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
 - applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
 - 
 - Some examples:
 - @example
 - # Use the default values
 - ocv=dilate
 - 
 - # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
 - ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
 - 
 - # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
 - # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
 - #   *
 - #  ***
 - # *****
 - #  ***
 - #   *
 - # The specified columns and rows are ignored
 - # but the anchor point coordinates are not
 - ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
 - @end example
 - 
 - @subsection erode
 - 
 - Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
 - It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
 - 
 - It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
 - with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
 - 
 - @subsection smooth
 - 
 - Smooth the input video.
 - 
 - The filter takes the following parameters:
 - @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
 - 
 - @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
 - the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
 - or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
 - 
 - The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
 - depend on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
 - @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
 - @var{param4} accept floating point values.
 - 
 - The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
 - other parameters is 0.
 - 
 - These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
 - libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
 - 
 - @anchor{overlay}
 - @section overlay
 - 
 - Overlay one video on top of another.
 - 
 - It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
 - video on which the second input is overlaid.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - A description of the accepted options follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
 - on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
 - the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
 - overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
 - 
 - @item eof_action
 - The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
 - one of the following values:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item repeat
 - Repeat the last frame (the default).
 - @item endall
 - End both streams.
 - @item pass
 - Pass the main input through.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item eval
 - Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item init
 - only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
 - when a command is processed
 - 
 - @item frame
 - evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{frame}.
 - 
 - @item shortest
 - If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
 - terminates. Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @item format
 - Set the format for the output video.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item yuv420
 - force YUV420 output
 - 
 - @item yuv422
 - force YUV422 output
 - 
 - @item yuv444
 - force YUV444 output
 - 
 - @item rgb
 - force RGB output
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
 - 
 - @item rgb @emph{(deprecated)}
 - If set to 1, force the filter to accept inputs in the RGB
 - color space. Default value is 0. This option is deprecated, use
 - @option{format} instead.
 - 
 - @item repeatlast
 - If set to 1, force the filter to draw the last overlay frame over the
 - main input until the end of the stream. A value of 0 disables this
 - behavior. Default value is 1.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
 - parameters.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item main_w, W
 - @item main_h, H
 - The main input width and height.
 - 
 - @item overlay_w, w
 - @item overlay_h, h
 - The overlay input width and height.
 - 
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
 - each new frame.
 - 
 - @item hsub
 - @item vsub
 - horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
 - format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
 - @var{vsub} is 1.
 - 
 - @item n
 - the number of input frame, starting from 0
 - 
 - @item pos
 - the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
 - 
 - @item t
 - The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
 - when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
 - when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
 - 
 - Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
 - order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
 - to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
 - have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
 - the @var{movie} filter does.
 - 
 - You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
 - efficiency of such approach.
 - 
 - @subsection Commands
 - 
 - This filter supports the following commands:
 - @table @option
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
 - The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
 - 
 - If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
 - value.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
 - video:
 - @example
 - overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
 - @end example
 - 
 - Using named options the example above becomes:
 - @example
 - overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
 - using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
 - right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
 - must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
 - @example
 - color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
 - filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
 - @example
 - ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
 - @end example
 - 
 - The above command is the same as:
 - @example
 - ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
 - screen starting since time 2:
 - @example
 - overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
 - nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
 - [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
 - [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
 - [background][left]       overlay=shortest=1       [background+left];
 - [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
 - "
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
 - -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
 - masked.avi
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Chain several overlays in cascade:
 - @example
 - nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
 - testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
 - [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg]   overlay=0:0     [mid0];
 - [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0   [mid1];
 - [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100   [mid2];
 - [in3] null,       [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section owdenoise
 - 
 - Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item depth
 - Set depth.
 - 
 - Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
 - slow down filtering.
 - 
 - Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
 - 
 - @item luma_strength, ls
 - Set luma strength.
 - 
 - Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
 - 
 - @item chroma_strength, cs
 - Set chroma strength.
 - 
 - Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{pad}
 - @section pad
 - 
 - Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
 - provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item width, w
 - @item height, h
 - Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
 - paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
 - corresponding input size is used for the output.
 - 
 - The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
 - @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
 - 
 - The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
 - 
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
 - with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
 - 
 - The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
 - expression, and vice versa.
 - 
 - The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
 - 
 - @item color
 - Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
 - check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
 - 
 - The default value of @var{color} is "black".
 - @end table
 - 
 - The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
 - options are expressions containing the following constants:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item in_w
 - @item in_h
 - The input video width and height.
 - 
 - @item iw
 - @item ih
 - These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
 - 
 - @item out_w
 - @item out_h
 - The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
 - specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
 - 
 - @item ow
 - @item oh
 - These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
 - 
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
 - expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
 - 
 - @item a
 - same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
 - 
 - @item sar
 - input sample aspect ratio
 - 
 - @item dar
 - input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
 - 
 - @item hsub
 - @item vsub
 - The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
 - size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
 - column 0, row 40
 - @example
 - pad=640:480:0:40:violet
 - @end example
 - 
 - The example above is equivalent to the following command:
 - @example
 - pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
 - and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
 - @example
 - pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
 - value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
 - the center of the padded area:
 - @example
 - pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
 - @example
 - pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
 - correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
 - according to the relation:
 - @example
 - (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
 - X = output_dar / sar
 - @end example
 - 
 - Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
 - @example
 - pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
 - corner of the output padded area:
 - @example
 - pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{palettegen}
 - @section palettegen
 - 
 - Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
 - 
 - It accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item max_colors
 - Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
 - Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
 - will be black.
 - 
 - @item reserve_transparent
 - Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
 - transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
 - If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
 - to disable this option for a standalone image.
 - Set by default.
 - 
 - @item stats_mode
 - Set statistics mode.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item full
 - Compute full frame histograms.
 - @item diff
 - Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
 - might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
 - the background is static.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @var{full}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
 - (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
 - color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
 - @var{info} logging level.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section paletteuse
 - 
 - Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
 - 
 - The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
 - be a 256 pixels image.
 - 
 - It accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item dither
 - Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item bayer
 - Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
 - @item heckbert
 - Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
 - Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
 - reference.
 - @item floyd_steinberg
 - Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
 - @item sierra2
 - Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
 - @item sierra2_4a
 - Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
 - 
 - @item bayer_scale
 - When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
 - pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
 - visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
 - at the cost of more banding.
 - 
 - The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
 - 
 - @item diff_mode
 - If set, define the zone to process
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item rectangle
 - Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
 - cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
 - if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
 - scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
 - moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
 - much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is @var{none}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
 - using @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section perspective
 - 
 - Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
 - 
 - A description of the accepted parameters follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item x0
 - @item y0
 - @item x1
 - @item y1
 - @item x2
 - @item y2
 - @item x3
 - @item y3
 - Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
 - Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
 - If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
 - to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
 - then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
 - 
 - The expressions can use the following variables:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item W
 - @item H
 - the width and height of video frame.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item interpolation
 - Set interpolation for perspective correction.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item linear
 - @item cubic
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{linear}.
 - 
 - @item sense
 - Set interpretation of coordinate options.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item 0, source
 - 
 - Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
 - the corners of the destination.
 - 
 - @item 1, destination
 - 
 - Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
 - by the given coordinates.
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{source}.
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section phase
 - 
 - Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
 - 
 - The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
 - opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
 - 
 - A description of the accepted parameters follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item mode
 - Set phase mode.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item t
 - Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
 - Filter will delay the bottom field.
 - 
 - @item b
 - Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
 - Filter will delay the top field.
 - 
 - @item p
 - Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
 - for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
 - actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
 - 
 - @item a
 - Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
 - opposite.
 - Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
 - basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
 - then this works just like @samp{u}.
 - 
 - @item u
 - Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
 - Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
 - analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
 - match between the fields.
 - 
 - @item T
 - Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
 - Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
 - 
 - @item B
 - Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
 - Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
 - 
 - @item A
 - Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
 - Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
 - image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
 - like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
 - 
 - @item U
 - Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
 - Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section pixdesctest
 - 
 - Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
 - testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
 - 
 - For example:
 - @example
 - format=monow, pixdesctest
 - @end example
 - 
 - can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
 - 
 - @section pp
 - 
 - Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
 - library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
 - Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
 - Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
 - interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
 - 
 - The filters accept the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item subfilters
 - Set postprocessing subfilters string.
 - @end table
 - 
 - All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item a/autoq
 - Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
 - 
 - @item c/chrom
 - Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
 - 
 - @item y/nochrom
 - Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
 - 
 - @item n/noluma
 - Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
 - @end table
 - 
 - These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
 - 
 - Available subfilters are:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
 - Horizontal deblocking filter
 - @table @option
 - @item difference
 - Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
 - @item flatness
 - Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
 - Vertical deblocking filter
 - @table @option
 - @item difference
 - Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
 - @item flatness
 - Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
 - Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
 - @table @option
 - @item difference
 - Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
 - @item flatness
 - Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
 - Accurate vertical deblocking filter
 - @table @option
 - @item difference
 - Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
 - @item flatness
 - Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
 - flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
 - thresholds.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item h1/x1hdeblock
 - Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
 - 
 - @item v1/x1vdeblock
 - Experimental vertical deblocking filter
 - 
 - @item dr/dering
 - Deringing filter
 - 
 - @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
 - @table @option
 - @item threshold1
 - larger -> stronger filtering
 - @item threshold2
 - larger -> stronger filtering
 - @item threshold3
 - larger -> stronger filtering
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
 - @table @option
 - @item f/fullyrange
 - Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item lb/linblenddeint
 - Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
 - filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
 - 
 - @item li/linipoldeint
 - Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
 - linearly interpolating every second line.
 - 
 - @item ci/cubicipoldeint
 - Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
 - cubically interpolating every second line.
 - 
 - @item md/mediandeint
 - Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
 - median filter to every second line.
 - 
 - @item fd/ffmpegdeint
 - FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
 - second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
 - 
 - @item l5/lowpass5
 - Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
 - block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
 - 
 - @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
 - Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
 - specify.
 - @table @option
 - @item quantizer
 - Quantizer to use
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item de/default
 - Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
 - 
 - @item fa/fast
 - Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
 - 
 - @item ac
 - High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
 - brightness/contrast:
 - @example
 - pp=hb/vb/dr/al
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
 - @example
 - pp=de/-al
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
 - @example
 - pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
 - automatically depending on available CPU time:
 - @example
 - pp=hb|y/vb|a
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section pp7
 - Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
 - similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
 - used after IDCT.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item qp
 - Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
 - 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
 - (if available).
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item hard
 - Set hard thresholding.
 - @item soft
 - Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
 - @item medium
 - Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section psnr
 - 
 - Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
 - Ratio) between two input videos.
 - 
 - This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
 - considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
 - output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
 - the PSNR.
 - 
 - Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
 - this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
 - have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
 - 
 - The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
 - 
 - The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
 - frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
 - equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
 - 
 - @example
 - PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
 - @end example
 - 
 - Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
 - image.
 - 
 - The description of the accepted parameters follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item stats_file, f
 - If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
 - each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
 - standard output.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
 - key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
 - couple of frames.
 - 
 - A description of each shown parameter follows:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
 - 
 - @item mse_avg
 - Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
 - frames, averaged over all the image components.
 - 
 - @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_g, mse_a
 - Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
 - frames for the component specified by the suffix.
 - 
 - @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
 - Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
 - specified by the suffix.
 - @end table
 - 
 - For example:
 - @example
 - movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
 - [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
 - @end example
 - 
 - On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
 - reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
 - is stored in @file{stats.log}.
 - 
 - @anchor{pullup}
 - @section pullup
 - 
 - Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
 - hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
 - content.
 - 
 - The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
 - its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
 - onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
 - fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
 - 
 - To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
 - pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
 - @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item jl
 - @item jr
 - @item jt
 - @item jb
 - These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
 - bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
 - while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
 - The default is 8 pixels on each side.
 - 
 - @item sb
 - Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
 - filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
 - excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
 - Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
 - This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
 - the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
 - Default value is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item mp
 - Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item l
 - Use luma plane.
 - 
 - @item u
 - Use chroma blue plane.
 - 
 - @item v
 - Use chroma red plane.
 - @end table
 - 
 - This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
 - for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
 - source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
 - is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
 - The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
 - load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
 - @end table
 - 
 - For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
 - necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
 - telecine NTSC input:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section qp
 - 
 - Change video quantization parameters (QP).
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following option:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item qp
 - Set expression for quantization parameter.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
 - the following constants:
 - 
 - @table @var
 - @item known
 - 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
 - 
 - @item qp
 - Sequentional index starting from -129 to 128.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Some equation like:
 - @example
 - qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section random
 - 
 - Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
 - No frame is discarded.
 - Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item frames
 - Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
 - @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
 - 
 - @item seed
 - Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
 - @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
 - less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
 - best effort basis.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section removegrain
 - 
 - The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item m0
 - Set mode for the first plane.
 - 
 - @item m1
 - Set mode for the second plane.
 - 
 - @item m2
 - Set mode for the third plane.
 - 
 - @item m3
 - Set mode for the fourth plane.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
 - 
 - @table @var
 - @item 0
 - Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
 - 
 - @item 1
 - Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
 - 
 - @item 2
 - Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
 - 
 - @item 3
 - Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
 - 
 - @item 4
 - Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
 - This is equivalent to a median filter.
 - 
 - @item 5
 - Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
 - 
 - @item 6
 - Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
 - 
 - @item 7
 - Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
 - 
 - @item 8
 - Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
 - 
 - @item 9
 - Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
 - 
 - @item 10
 - Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
 - 
 - @item 11
 - [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
 - 
 - @item 12
 - Same as mode 11.
 - 
 - @item 13
 - Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
 - pixels are the closest.
 - 
 - @item 14
 - Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
 - pixels are the closest.
 - 
 - @item 15
 - Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
 - interpolation formula.
 - 
 - @item 16
 - Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
 - interpolation formula.
 - 
 - @item 17
 - Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
 - minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
 - 
 - @item 18
 - Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
 - the current pixel is minimal.
 - 
 - @item 19
 - Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
 - 
 - @item 20
 - Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
 - 
 - @item 21
 - Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
 - 
 - @item 22
 - Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
 - 
 - @item 23
 - Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
 - 
 - @item 24
 - Similar as 23.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section removelogo
 - 
 - Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
 - pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
 - comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item filename, f
 - Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
 - libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
 - video stream being processed.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
 - considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
 - the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
 - rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
 - recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
 - visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
 - filter once or twice.
 - 
 - If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
 - logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
 - reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
 - much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
 - the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
 - pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
 - 
 - @section repeatfields
 - 
 - This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
 - fields based on its value.
 - 
 - @section reverse, areverse
 - 
 - Reverse a clip.
 - 
 - Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
 - is suggested.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
 - @example
 - trim=end=5,reverse
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section rotate
 - 
 - Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - A description of the optional parameters follows.
 - @table @option
 - @item angle, a
 - Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
 - clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
 - result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
 - 
 - This expression is evaluated for each frame.
 - 
 - @item out_w, ow
 - Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
 - This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
 - 
 - @item out_h, oh
 - Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
 - This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
 - 
 - @item bilinear
 - Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
 - it. Default value is 1.
 - 
 - @item fillcolor, c
 - Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
 - image. For the general syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
 - ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special value "none" is selected then no
 - background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
 - 
 - Default value is "black".
 - @end table
 - 
 - The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
 - following constants and functions:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
 - before the first frame is filtered.
 - 
 - @item t
 - time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
 - configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
 - 
 - @item hsub
 - @item vsub
 - horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - 
 - @item in_w, iw
 - @item in_h, ih
 - the input video width and height
 - 
 - @item out_w, ow
 - @item out_h, oh
 - the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
 - specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
 - 
 - @item rotw(a)
 - @item roth(a)
 - the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
 - video rotated by @var{a} radians.
 - 
 - These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
 - @option{out_h} expressions.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
 - @example
 - rotate=PI/6
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
 - @example
 - rotate=-PI/6
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
 - @example
 - rotate=45*PI/180
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
 - @example
 - rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
 - seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
 - @example
 - rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
 - input video is always completely contained in the output:
 - @example
 - rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
 - shown:
 - @example
 - rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @subsection Commands
 - 
 - The filter supports the following commands:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item a, angle
 - Set the angle expression.
 - The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
 - 
 - If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
 - value.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section sab
 - 
 - Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item luma_radius, lr
 - Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
 - value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
 - in slower processing.
 - 
 - @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
 - Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
 - value is 1.0.
 - 
 - @item luma_strength, ls
 - Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
 - be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
 - 
 - @item chroma_radius, cr
 - Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0. A
 - greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
 - processing.
 - 
 - @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
 - Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range.
 - 
 - @item chroma_strength, cs
 - Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
 - must be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
 - corresponding luma option value.
 - 
 - @anchor{scale}
 - @section scale
 - 
 - Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
 - 
 - The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
 - of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
 - 
 - If the input image format is different from the format requested by
 - the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
 - requested format.
 - 
 - @subsection Options
 - The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
 - supported by the libswscale scaler.
 - 
 - See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
 - the complete list of scaler options.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item width, w
 - @item height, h
 - Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
 - dimension.
 - 
 - If the value is 0, the input width is used for the output.
 - 
 - If one of the values is -1, the scale filter will use a value that
 - maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the
 - other specified dimension. If both of them are -1, the input size is
 - used
 - 
 - If one of the values is -n with n > 1, the scale filter will also use a value
 - that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other
 - specified dimension. After that it will, however, make sure that the calculated
 - dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value if necessary.
 - 
 - See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
 - expression.
 - 
 - @item interl
 - Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item 1
 - Force interlaced aware scaling.
 - 
 - @item 0
 - Do not apply interlaced scaling.
 - 
 - @item -1
 - Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
 - are flagged as interlaced or not.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{0}.
 - 
 - @item flags
 - Set libswscale scaling flags. See
 - @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
 - complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
 - the default flags.
 - 
 - @item size, s
 - Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - 
 - @item in_color_matrix
 - @item out_color_matrix
 - Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
 - 
 - This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
 - a specific value used for the output and encoder.
 - 
 - If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
 - 
 - Possible values:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item auto
 - Choose automatically.
 - 
 - @item bt709
 - Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
 - Recommendation BT.709.
 - 
 - @item fcc
 - Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
 - Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
 - 
 - @item bt601
 - Set color space conforming to:
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
 - 
 - @item
 - ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
 - 
 - @item
 - Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @item smpte240m
 - Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item in_range
 - @item out_range
 - Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
 - 
 - This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
 - a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
 - range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item auto
 - Choose automatically.
 - 
 - @item jpeg/full/pc
 - Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
 - 
 - @item mpeg/tv
 - Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item force_original_aspect_ratio
 - Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
 - keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item disable
 - Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
 - 
 - @item decrease
 - The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
 - 
 - @item increase
 - The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
 - maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
 - that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
 - 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
 - decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
 - 1280x533.
 - 
 - Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
 - or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
 - to work.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
 - containing the following constants:
 - 
 - @table @var
 - @item in_w
 - @item in_h
 - The input width and height
 - 
 - @item iw
 - @item ih
 - These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
 - 
 - @item out_w
 - @item out_h
 - The output (scaled) width and height
 - 
 - @item ow
 - @item oh
 - These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
 - 
 - @item a
 - The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
 - 
 - @item sar
 - input sample aspect ratio
 - 
 - @item dar
 - The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
 - 
 - @item hsub
 - @item vsub
 - horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - 
 - @item ohsub
 - @item ovsub
 - horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
 - @example
 - scale=w=200:h=100
 - @end example
 - 
 - This is equivalent to:
 - @example
 - scale=200:100
 - @end example
 - 
 - or:
 - @example
 - scale=200x100
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
 - @example
 - scale=qcif
 - @end example
 - 
 - which can also be written as:
 - @example
 - scale=size=qcif
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Scale the input to 2x:
 - @example
 - scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - The above is the same as:
 - @example
 - scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
 - @example
 - scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Scale the input to half size:
 - @example
 - scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
 - @example
 - scale=3/2*iw:ow
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Seek Greek harmony:
 - @example
 - scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
 - scale=ih*PHI:ih
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
 - @example
 - scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
 - subsample values:
 - @example
 - scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
 - keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
 - @example
 - scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @subsection Commands
 - 
 - This filter supports the following commands:
 - @table @option
 - @item width, w
 - @item height, h
 - Set the output video dimension expression.
 - The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
 - 
 - If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
 - value.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section scale2ref
 - 
 - Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
 - 
 - See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
 - uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Scale a subtitle stream to match the main video in size before overlaying
 - @example
 - 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section selectivecolor
 - 
 - Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
 - as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
 - by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
 - 
 - This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item correction_method
 - Select color correction method.
 - 
 - Available values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item absolute
 - Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
 - component value).
 - @item relative
 - Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
 - @end table
 - Default is @code{absolute}.
 - @item reds
 - Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
 - @item yellows
 - Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
 - @item greens
 - Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
 - @item cyans
 - Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
 - @item blues
 - Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
 - @item magentas
 - Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
 - @item whites
 - Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
 - @item neutrals
 - Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
 - @item blacks
 - Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
 - @item psfile
 - Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
 - @end table
 - 
 - All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
 - 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
 - respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
 - pixels of its range.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
 - increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
 - @example
 - selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
 - @example
 - selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section separatefields
 - 
 - The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
 - each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
 - with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
 - 
 - This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
 - of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
 - If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
 - 
 - @section setdar, setsar
 - 
 - The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
 - output video.
 - 
 - This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
 - Ratio, according to the following equation:
 - @example
 - @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
 - @end example
 - 
 - Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
 - dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
 - this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
 - e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
 - applied.
 - 
 - The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
 - the filter output video.
 - 
 - Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
 - output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
 - above.
 - 
 - Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
 - filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
 - another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
 - Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
 - 
 - The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
 - a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
 - @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
 - the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
 - In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
 - should be escaped.
 - 
 - @item max
 - Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
 - denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
 - Default value is @code{100}.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
 - the following constants:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item E, PI, PHI
 - These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
 - (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
 - 
 - @item w, h
 - The input width and height.
 - 
 - @item a
 - These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
 - 
 - @item sar
 - The input sample aspect ratio.
 - 
 - @item dar
 - The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
 - (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
 - 
 - @item hsub, vsub
 - Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - 
 - @item
 - To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
 - @example
 - setdar=dar=1.77777
 - setdar=dar=16/9
 - setdar=dar=1.77777
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
 - @example
 - setsar=sar=10/11
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
 - 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
 - @example
 - setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{setfield}
 - @section setfield
 - 
 - Force field for the output video frame.
 - 
 - The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
 - output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
 - corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
 - following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Available values are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item auto
 - Keep the same field property.
 - 
 - @item bff
 - Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
 - 
 - @item tff
 - Mark the frame as top-field-first.
 - 
 - @item prog
 - Mark the frame as progressive.
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section showinfo
 - 
 - Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
 - The input video is not modified.
 - 
 - The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
 - @var{key}:@var{value}.
 - 
 - The following values are shown in the output:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
 - 
 - @item pts
 - The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
 - time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
 - 
 - @item pts_time
 - The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
 - seconds.
 - 
 - @item pos
 - The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
 - unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
 - 
 - @item fmt
 - The pixel format name.
 - 
 - @item sar
 - The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
 - @var{num}/@var{den}.
 - 
 - @item s
 - The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - 
 - @item i
 - The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
 - for bottom field first).
 - 
 - @item iskey
 - This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
 - 
 - @item type
 - The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
 - P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
 - Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
 - the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
 - @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
 - 
 - @item checksum
 - The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
 - 
 - @item plane_checksum
 - The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
 - expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section showpalette
 - 
 - Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
 - @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
 - 
 - It accepts the following option:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item s
 - Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
 - @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section shuffleframes
 - 
 - Reorder and/or duplicate video frames.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item mapping
 - Set the destination indexes of input frames.
 - This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
 - frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
 - 
 - Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section shuffleplanes
 - 
 - Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item map0
 - The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
 - 
 - @item map1
 - The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
 - 
 - @item map2
 - The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
 - 
 - @item map3
 - The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
 - 
 - Swap the second and third planes of the input:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
 - @end example
 - 
 - @anchor{signalstats}
 - @section signalstats
 - Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
 - with the digitization of analog video media.
 - 
 - By default the filter will log these metadata values:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item YMIN
 - Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item YLOW
 - Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item YAVG
 - Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
 - [0-255].
 - 
 - @item YHIGH
 - Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item YMAX
 - Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item UMIN
 - Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item ULOW
 - Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item UAVG
 - Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
 - [0-255].
 - 
 - @item UHIGH
 - Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item UMAX
 - Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item VMIN
 - Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item VLOW
 - Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item VAVG
 - Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
 - [0-255].
 - 
 - @item VHIGH
 - Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item VMAX
 - Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
 - range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item SATMIN
 - Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
 - Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
 - 
 - @item SATLOW
 - Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
 - Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
 - 
 - @item SATAVG
 - Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
 - of [0-~181.02].
 - 
 - @item SATHIGH
 - Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
 - Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
 - 
 - @item SATMAX
 - Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
 - Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
 - 
 - @item HUEMED
 - Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
 - [0-360].
 - 
 - @item HUEAVG
 - Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
 - [0-360].
 - 
 - @item YDIF
 - Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
 - plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
 - Expressed in range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item UDIF
 - Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
 - plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
 - Expressed in range of [0-255].
 - 
 - @item VDIF
 - Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
 - plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
 - Expressed in range of [0-255].
 - @end table
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item stat
 - @item out
 - 
 - @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
 - @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
 - 
 - Both options accept the following values:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item tout
 - Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
 - unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
 - include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
 - 
 - @item vrep
 - Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
 - similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
 - repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
 - analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
 - analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
 - 
 - @item brng
 - Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item color, c
 - Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
 - yellow.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Output data of various video metrics:
 - @example
 - ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
 - @example
 - ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
 - @example
 - ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
 - @example
 - ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
 - @end example
 - 
 - The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
 - @example
 - time %@{pts:hms@}
 - Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
 - U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
 - V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
 - saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
 - 
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{smartblur}
 - @section smartblur
 - 
 - Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
 - 
 - It accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item luma_radius, lr
 - Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
 - the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
 - used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
 - 
 - @item luma_strength, ls
 - Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
 - in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
 - in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
 - [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
 - 
 - @item luma_threshold, lt
 - Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
 - whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
 - integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
 - a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
 - in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @item chroma_radius, cr
 - Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
 - the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
 - used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
 - 
 - @item chroma_strength, cs
 - Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
 - in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
 - in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
 - [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
 - 
 - @item chroma_threshold, ct
 - Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
 - whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
 - integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
 - a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
 - in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
 - @end table
 - 
 - If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
 - is set.
 - 
 - @section ssim
 - 
 - Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
 - 
 - This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
 - considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
 - output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
 - the SSIM.
 - 
 - Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
 - this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
 - have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
 - 
 - The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
 - 
 - The description of the accepted parameters follows.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item stats_file, f
 - If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
 - each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
 - standard output.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
 - key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
 - couple of frames.
 - 
 - A description of each shown parameter follows:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
 - 
 - @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
 - SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
 - 
 - @item All
 - SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
 - 
 - @item dB
 - Same as above but in dB representation.
 - @end table
 - 
 - For example:
 - @example
 - movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
 - [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
 - @end example
 - 
 - On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
 - reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
 - is stored in @file{stats.log}.
 - 
 - Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi  "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section stereo3d
 - 
 - Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
 - 
 - The filters accept the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item in
 - Set stereoscopic image format of input.
 - 
 - Available values for input image formats are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item sbsl
 - side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
 - 
 - @item sbsr
 - side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
 - 
 - @item sbs2l
 - side by side parallel with half width resolution
 - (left eye left, right eye right)
 - 
 - @item sbs2r
 - side by side crosseye with half width resolution
 - (right eye left, left eye right)
 - 
 - @item abl
 - above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
 - 
 - @item abr
 - above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
 - 
 - @item ab2l
 - above-below with half height resolution
 - (left eye above, right eye below)
 - 
 - @item ab2r
 - above-below with half height resolution
 - (right eye above, left eye below)
 - 
 - @item al
 - alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
 - 
 - @item ar
 - alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
 - 
 - @item irl
 - interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
 - 
 - @item irr
 - interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
 - 
 - @item icl
 - interleaved columns, left eye first
 - 
 - @item icr
 - interleaved columns, right eye first
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item out
 - Set stereoscopic image format of output.
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item sbsl
 - side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
 - 
 - @item sbsr
 - side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
 - 
 - @item sbs2l
 - side by side parallel with half width resolution
 - (left eye left, right eye right)
 - 
 - @item sbs2r
 - side by side crosseye with half width resolution
 - (right eye left, left eye right)
 - 
 - @item abl
 - above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
 - 
 - @item abr
 - above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
 - 
 - @item ab2l
 - above-below with half height resolution
 - (left eye above, right eye below)
 - 
 - @item ab2r
 - above-below with half height resolution
 - (right eye above, left eye below)
 - 
 - @item al
 - alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
 - 
 - @item ar
 - alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
 - 
 - @item irl
 - interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
 - 
 - @item irr
 - interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
 - 
 - @item arbg
 - anaglyph red/blue gray
 - (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item argg
 - anaglyph red/green gray
 - (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item arcg
 - anaglyph red/cyan gray
 - (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item arch
 - anaglyph red/cyan half colored
 - (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item arcc
 - anaglyph red/cyan color
 - (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item arcd
 - anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
 - (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item agmg
 - anaglyph green/magenta gray
 - (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item agmh
 - anaglyph green/magenta half colored
 - (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item agmc
 - anaglyph green/magenta colored
 - (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item agmd
 - anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
 - (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item aybg
 - anaglyph yellow/blue gray
 - (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item aybh
 - anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
 - (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item aybc
 - anaglyph yellow/blue colored
 - (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item aybd
 - anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
 - (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
 - 
 - @item ml
 - mono output (left eye only)
 - 
 - @item mr
 - mono output (right eye only)
 - 
 - @item chl
 - checkerboard, left eye first
 - 
 - @item chr
 - checkerboard, right eye first
 - 
 - @item icl
 - interleaved columns, left eye first
 - 
 - @item icr
 - interleaved columns, right eye first
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{arcd}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
 - @example
 - stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
 - @example
 - stereo3d=abl:sbsr
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{spp}
 - @section spp
 - 
 - Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
 - at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
 - and average the results.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item quality
 - Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
 - an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
 - effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
 - that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2.  Default value is
 - @code{3}.
 - 
 - @item qp
 - Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
 - from the video stream (if available).
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item hard
 - Set hard thresholding (default).
 - @item soft
 - Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item use_bframe_qp
 - Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
 - option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
 - @code{0} (not enabled).
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{subtitles}
 - @section subtitles
 - 
 - Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
 - 
 - To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
 - @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
 - libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
 - Alpha) subtitles format.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item filename, f
 - Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
 - 
 - @item original_size
 - Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
 - was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
 - correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
 - 
 - @item fontsdir
 - Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
 - These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
 - 
 - @item charenc
 - Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
 - useful if not UTF-8.
 - 
 - @item stream_index, si
 - Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
 - 
 - @item force_style
 - Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
 - string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
 - @end table
 - 
 - If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
 - specifies the @option{filename}.
 - 
 - For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
 - video, use the command:
 - @example
 - subtitles=sub.srt
 - @end example
 - 
 - which is equivalent to:
 - @example
 - subtitles=filename=sub.srt
 - @end example
 - 
 - To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
 - @example
 - subtitles=video.mkv
 - @end example
 - 
 - To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
 - @example
 - subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
 - @end example
 - 
 - To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in transparent green
 - @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
 - @example
 - subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HAA00FF00'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section super2xsai
 - 
 - Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
 - Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
 - 
 - Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
 - 
 - @section swapuv
 - Swap U & V plane.
 - 
 - @section telecine
 - 
 - Apply telecine process to the video.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item first_field
 - @table @samp
 - @item top, t
 - top field first
 - @item bottom, b
 - bottom field first
 - The default value is @code{top}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item pattern
 - A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
 - The default value is @code{23}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @example
 - Some typical patterns:
 - 
 - NTSC output (30i):
 - 27.5p: 32222
 - 24p: 23 (classic)
 - 24p: 2332 (preferred)
 - 20p: 33
 - 18p: 334
 - 16p: 3444
 - 
 - PAL output (25i):
 - 27.5p: 12222
 - 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
 - 16.67p: 33
 - 16p: 33333334
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section thumbnail
 - Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
 - will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
 - the end. Default is @code{100}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
 - value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Extract one picture each 50 frames:
 - @example
 - thumbnail=50
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section tile
 - 
 - Tile several successive frames together.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item layout
 - Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
 - this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - 
 - @item nb_frames
 - Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
 - than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
 - the area will be used.
 - 
 - @item margin
 - Set the outer border margin in pixels.
 - 
 - @item padding
 - Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
 - more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
 - refer to the pad video filter.
 - 
 - @item color
 - Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. The default value of @var{color}
 - is "black".
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
 - @end example
 - The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
 - duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
 - rate.
 - 
 - @item
 - Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
 - with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
 - mixed flat and named options:
 - @example
 - tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section tinterlace
 - 
 - Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
 - 
 - Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
 - considered odd.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
 - as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
 - 
 - Available values are:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item merge, 0
 - Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
 - generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
 - @example
 -  ------> time
 - Input:
 - Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4
 - 
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 
 - Output:
 - 11111                           33333
 - 22222                           44444
 - 11111                           33333
 - 22222                           44444
 - 11111                           33333
 - 22222                           44444
 - 11111                           33333
 - 22222                           44444
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item drop_odd, 1
 - Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
 - unchanged height at half frame rate.
 - 
 - @example
 -  ------> time
 - Input:
 - Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4
 - 
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 
 - Output:
 -                 22222                           44444
 -                 22222                           44444
 -                 22222                           44444
 -                 22222                           44444
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item drop_even, 2
 - Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
 - unchanged height at half frame rate.
 - 
 - @example
 -  ------> time
 - Input:
 - Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4
 - 
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 
 - Output:
 - 11111                           33333
 - 11111                           33333
 - 11111                           33333
 - 11111                           33333
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item pad, 3
 - Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
 - generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
 - 
 - @example
 -  ------> time
 - Input:
 - Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4
 - 
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 
 - Output:
 - 11111           .....           33333           .....
 - .....           22222           .....           44444
 - 11111           .....           33333           .....
 - .....           22222           .....           44444
 - 11111           .....           33333           .....
 - .....           22222           .....           44444
 - 11111           .....           33333           .....
 - .....           22222           .....           44444
 - @end example
 - 
 - 
 - @item interleave_top, 4
 - Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
 - even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
 - 
 - @example
 -  ------> time
 - Input:
 - Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4
 - 
 - 11111<-         22222           33333<-         44444
 - 11111           22222<-         33333           44444<-
 - 11111<-         22222           33333<-         44444
 - 11111           22222<-         33333           44444<-
 - 
 - Output:
 - 11111                           33333
 - 22222                           44444
 - 11111                           33333
 - 22222                           44444
 - @end example
 - 
 - 
 - @item interleave_bottom, 5
 - Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
 - even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
 - 
 - @example
 -  ------> time
 - Input:
 - Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4
 - 
 - 11111           22222<-         33333           44444<-
 - 11111<-         22222           33333<-         44444
 - 11111           22222<-         33333           44444<-
 - 11111<-         22222           33333<-         44444
 - 
 - Output:
 - 22222                           44444
 - 11111                           33333
 - 22222                           44444
 - 11111                           33333
 - @end example
 - 
 - 
 - @item interlacex2, 6
 - Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
 - containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
 - the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
 - the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
 - field synchronisation.
 - 
 - @example
 -  ------> time
 - Input:
 - Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4
 - 
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 -  11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 -  11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 
 - Output:
 - 11111   22222   22222   33333   33333   44444   44444
 -  11111   11111   22222   22222   33333   33333   44444
 - 11111   22222   22222   33333   33333   44444   44444
 -  11111   11111   22222   22222   33333   33333   44444
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item mergex2, 7
 - Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
 - generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
 - @example
 -  ------> time
 - Input:
 - Frame 1         Frame 2         Frame 3         Frame 4
 - 
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 11111           22222           33333           44444
 - 
 - Output:
 - 11111           33333           33333           55555
 - 22222           22222           44444           44444
 - 11111           33333           33333           55555
 - 22222           22222           44444           44444
 - 11111           33333           33333           55555
 - 22222           22222           44444           44444
 - 11111           33333           33333           55555
 - 22222           22222           44444           44444
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
 - compatibility reasons.
 - 
 - Default mode is @code{merge}.
 - 
 - @item flags
 - Specify flags influencing the filter process.
 - 
 - Available value for @var{flags} is:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item low_pass_filter, vlfp
 - Enable vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
 - Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
 - destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
 - vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
 - patterning.
 - 
 - Vertical low-pass filtering can only be enabled for @option{mode}
 - @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
 - 
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section transpose
 - 
 - Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item dir
 - Specify the transposition direction.
 - 
 - Can assume the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
 - Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
 - @example
 - L.R     L.l
 - . . ->  . .
 - l.r     R.r
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item 1, 5, clock
 - Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
 - @example
 - L.R     l.L
 - . . ->  . .
 - l.r     r.R
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item 2, 6, cclock
 - Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
 - @example
 - L.R     R.r
 - . . ->  . .
 - l.r     L.l
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item 3, 7, clock_flip
 - Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
 - @example
 - L.R     r.R
 - . . ->  . .
 - l.r     l.L
 - @end example
 - @end table
 - 
 - For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
 - video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
 - deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
 - 
 - Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
 - symbolic constants.
 - 
 - @item passthrough
 - Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
 - specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item none
 - Always apply transposition.
 - @item portrait
 - Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
 - @item landscape
 - Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @code{none}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
 - layout:
 - @example
 - transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
 - @end example
 - 
 - The command above can also be specified as:
 - @example
 - transpose=1:portrait
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section trim
 - Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - @table @option
 - @item start
 - Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
 - timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
 - 
 - @item end
 - Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
 - immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
 - frame in the output.
 - 
 - @item start_pts
 - This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
 - in timebase units instead of seconds.
 - 
 - @item end_pts
 - This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
 - in timebase units instead of seconds.
 - 
 - @item duration
 - The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
 - 
 - @item start_frame
 - The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
 - 
 - @item end_frame
 - The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
 - duration specifications; see
 - @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
 - for the accepted syntax.
 - 
 - Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
 - option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
 - frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
 - the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
 - setpts filter after the trim filter.
 - 
 - If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
 - keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
 - only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
 - filters.
 - 
 - The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
 - just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
 - 
 - Examples:
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Drop everything except the second minute of input:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Keep only the first second:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - 
 - @anchor{unsharp}
 - @section unsharp
 - 
 - Sharpen or blur the input video.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item luma_msize_x, lx
 - Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
 - 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
 - 
 - @item luma_msize_y, ly
 - Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
 - and 63. The default value is 5.
 - 
 - @item luma_amount, la
 - Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
 - values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
 - 
 - Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
 - sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
 - 
 - Default value is 1.0.
 - 
 - @item chroma_msize_x, cx
 - Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
 - between 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
 - 
 - @item chroma_msize_y, cy
 - Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
 - between 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
 - 
 - @item chroma_amount, ca
 - Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
 - values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
 - 
 - Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
 - sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
 - 
 - Default value is 0.0.
 - 
 - @item opencl
 - If set to 1, specify using OpenCL capabilities, only available if
 - FFmpeg was configured with @code{--enable-opencl}. Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
 - string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
 - @example
 - unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
 - @example
 - unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section uspp
 - 
 - Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
 - the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
 - shifts and average the results.
 - 
 - The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
 - decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
 - DCT similar to MJPEG.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item quality
 - Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
 - an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
 - effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
 - that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2.  Default value is
 - @code{3}.
 - 
 - @item qp
 - Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
 - from the video stream (if available).
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section vectorscope
 - 
 - Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
 - a vectorscope).
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item mode, m
 - Set vectorscope mode.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item gray
 - Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
 - same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
 - 
 - @item color
 - Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
 - present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
 - set by option @code{x} and @code{y}.
 - 
 - @item color2
 - Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
 - 
 - @item color3
 - Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
 - on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
 - default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
 - 
 - @item color4
 - Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
 - colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
 - not present in graph is picked.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item x
 - Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
 - 
 - @item y
 - Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
 - 
 - @item intensity, i
 - Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color and color3 for increasing brightness
 - of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
 - 
 - @item envelope, e
 - @table @samp
 - @item none
 - No envelope, this is default.
 - 
 - @item instant
 - Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
 - 
 - @item peak
 - Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
 - can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
 - 
 - @item peak+instant
 - Peak and instant envelope combined together.
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{vidstabdetect}
 - @section vidstabdetect
 - 
 - Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
 - @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
 - 
 - This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
 - transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
 - the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
 - 
 - To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
 - @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item result
 - Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
 - Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
 - 
 - @item shakiness
 - Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
 - integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
 - value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
 - 
 - @item accuracy
 - Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
 - range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
 - accuracy. Default value is 15.
 - 
 - @item stepsize
 - Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
 - scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
 - 
 - @item mincontrast
 - Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
 - discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
 - value is 0.3.
 - 
 - @item tripod
 - Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
 - 
 - If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
 - in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
 - is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
 - the camera view absolutely still.
 - 
 - If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
 - 
 - @item show
 - Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
 - integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
 - visualization.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Use default values:
 - @example
 - vidstabdetect
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
 - @file{mytransforms.trf}:
 - @example
 - vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
 - video:
 - @example
 - vidstabdetect=show=1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{vidstabtransform}
 - @section vidstabtransform
 - 
 - Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
 - see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
 - 
 - Read a file with transform information for each frame and
 - apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
 - filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
 - @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
 - the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
 - 
 - To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
 - @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
 - 
 - @subsection Options
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item input
 - Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
 - @file{transforms.trf}.
 - 
 - @item smoothing
 - Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
 - camera movements. Default value is 10.
 - 
 - For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
 - past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
 - larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
 - the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
 - camera is simulated.
 - 
 - @item optalgo
 - Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
 - 
 - Accepted values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item gauss
 - gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
 - @item avg
 - averaging on transformations
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item maxshift
 - Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
 - meaning no limit.
 - 
 - @item maxangle
 - Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
 - value is -1, meaning no limit.
 - 
 - @item crop
 - Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
 - compensation.
 - 
 - Available values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item keep
 - keep image information from previous frame (default)
 - @item black
 - fill the border black
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item invert
 - Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @item relative
 - Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
 - absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @item zoom
 - Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
 - effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
 - zoom).
 - 
 - @item optzoom
 - Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
 - 
 - Accepted values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item 0
 - disabled
 - @item 1
 - optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
 - will lead to visible borders) (default)
 - @item 2
 - optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
 - visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
 - @end table
 - 
 - Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
 - 
 - @item zoomspeed
 - Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
 - @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
 - 0.25.
 - 
 - @item interpol
 - Specify type of interpolation.
 - 
 - Available values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item no
 - no interpolation
 - @item linear
 - linear only horizontal
 - @item bilinear
 - linear in both directions (default)
 - @item bicubic
 - cubic in both directions (slow)
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item tripod
 - Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
 - @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
 - 
 - Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
 - 
 - @item debug
 - Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
 - are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
 - value is 0.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
 - @end example
 - 
 - Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
 - 
 - @item
 - Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
 - @example
 - vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Smoothen the video even more:
 - @example
 - vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section vflip
 - 
 - Flip the input video vertically.
 - 
 - For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
 - @end example
 - 
 - @anchor{vignette}
 - @section vignette
 - 
 - Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item angle, a
 - Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
 - 
 - The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
 - 
 - Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
 - 
 - @item x0
 - @item y0
 - Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
 - by default.
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Set forward/backward mode.
 - 
 - Available modes are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item forward
 - The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
 - 
 - @item backward
 - The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
 - This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
 - detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
 - also be used to create a burning effect.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{forward}.
 - 
 - @item eval
 - Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item init
 - Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
 - 
 - @item frame
 - Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
 - @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
 - allows advanced dynamic expressions.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{init}.
 - 
 - @item dither
 - Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
 - (enabled).
 - 
 - @item aspect
 - Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
 - Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
 - following the dimensions of the video.
 - 
 - Default is @code{1/1}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Expressions
 - 
 - The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
 - following parameters.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item w
 - @item h
 - input width and height
 - 
 - @item n
 - the number of input frame, starting from 0
 - 
 - @item pts
 - the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
 - @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
 - 
 - @item r
 - frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
 - 
 - @item t
 - the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
 - expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
 - 
 - @item tb
 - time base of the input video
 - @end table
 - 
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
 - @example
 - vignette=PI/4
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Make a flickering vignetting:
 - @example
 - vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section vstack
 - Stack input videos vertically.
 - 
 - All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
 - 
 - Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
 - to create same output.
 - 
 - The filter accept the following option:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item inputs
 - Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
 - 
 - @item shortest
 - If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
 - terminates. Default value is 0.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section w3fdif
 - 
 - Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
 - Deinterlacing Filter").
 - 
 - Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
 - implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
 - Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
 - uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
 - 
 - There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple":
 - and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
 - be set by passing an optional parameter:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item filter
 - Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item simple
 - Simple filter coefficient set.
 - @item complex
 - More-complex filter coefficient set.
 - @end table
 - Default value is @samp{complex}.
 - 
 - @item deint
 - Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following values:
 - 
 - @table @samp
 - @item all
 - Deinterlace all frames,
 - @item interlaced
 - Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{all}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section waveform
 - Video waveform monitor.
 - 
 - The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
 - only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
 - source video.
 - 
 - It accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item mode, m
 - Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
 - In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
 - the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
 - color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
 - 
 - @item intensity, i
 - Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
 - luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
 - Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
 - 
 - @item mirror, r
 - Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
 - In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
 - side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
 - @code{1} (mirrored).
 - 
 - @item display, d
 - Set display mode.
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item overlay
 - Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
 - that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
 - over one another.
 - 
 - This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
 - in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
 - such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
 - 
 - @item parade
 - Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
 - @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
 - 
 - Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
 - and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
 - graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
 - by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
 - should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
 - correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
 - @end table
 - Default is @code{parade}.
 - 
 - @item components, c
 - Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
 - or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
 - 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
 - 
 - @item envelope, e
 - @table @samp
 - @item none
 - No envelope, this is default.
 - 
 - @item instant
 - Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
 - visible even with small @code{step} value.
 - 
 - @item peak
 - Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
 - can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
 - 
 - @item peak+instant
 - Peak and instant envelope combined together.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item filter, f
 - @table @samp
 - @item lowpass
 - No filtering, this is default.
 - 
 - @item flat
 - Luma and chroma combined together.
 - 
 - @item aflat
 - Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
 - 
 - @item chroma
 - Displays only chroma.
 - 
 - @item achroma
 - Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
 - 
 - @item color
 - Displays actual color value on waveform.
 - @end table
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section xbr
 - Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
 - art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
 - @url{http://www.libretro.com/forums/viewtopic.php?f=6&t=134}.
 - 
 - It accepts the following option:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
 - @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
 - Default is @code{3}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @anchor{yadif}
 - @section yadif
 - 
 - Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
 - filter").
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item mode
 - The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item 0, send_frame
 - Output one frame for each frame.
 - @item 1, send_field
 - Output one frame for each field.
 - @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
 - Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
 - @item 3, send_field_nospatial
 - Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The default value is @code{send_frame}.
 - 
 - @item parity
 - The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
 - of the following values:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item 0, tff
 - Assume the top field is first.
 - @item 1, bff
 - Assume the bottom field is first.
 - @item -1, auto
 - Enable automatic detection of field parity.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The default value is @code{auto}.
 - If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
 - top field first will be assumed.
 - 
 - @item deint
 - Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following
 - values:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item 0, all
 - Deinterlace all frames.
 - @item 1, interlaced
 - Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The default value is @code{all}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section zoompan
 - 
 - Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item zoom, z
 - Set the zoom expression. Default is 1.
 - 
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item d
 - Set the duration expression in number of frames.
 - This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
 - single input image.
 - 
 - @item s
 - Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Each expression can contain the following constants:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item in_w, iw
 - Input width.
 - 
 - @item in_h, ih
 - Input height.
 - 
 - @item out_w, ow
 - Output width.
 - 
 - @item out_h, oh
 - Output height.
 - 
 - @item in
 - Input frame count.
 - 
 - @item on
 - Output frame count.
 - 
 - @item x
 - @item y
 - Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
 - for current input frame.
 - 
 - @item px
 - @item py
 - 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
 - not yet such frame (first input frame).
 - 
 - @item zoom
 - Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
 - 
 - @item pzoom
 - Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
 - 
 - @item duration
 - Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
 - for each input frame.
 - 
 - @item pduration
 - number of output frames created for previous input frame
 - 
 - @item a
 - Rational number: input width / input height
 - 
 - @item sar
 - sample aspect ratio
 - 
 - @item dar
 - display aspect ratio
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
 - @example
 - zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
 - @example
 - zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section zscale
 - Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
 - https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg.
 - 
 - The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
 - as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
 - 
 - If the input image format is different from the format requested by
 - the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
 - requested format.
 - 
 - @subsection Options
 - The filter accepts the following options.
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item width, w
 - @item height, h
 - Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
 - dimension.
 - 
 - If the @var{width} or @var{w} is 0, the input width is used for the output.
 - If the @var{height} or @var{h} is 0, the input height is used for the output.
 - 
 - If one of the values is -1, the zscale filter will use a value that
 - maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the
 - other specified dimension. If both of them are -1, the input size is
 - used
 - 
 - If one of the values is -n with n > 1, the zscale filter will also use a value
 - that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other
 - specified dimension. After that it will, however, make sure that the calculated
 - dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value if necessary.
 - 
 - See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
 - expression.
 - 
 - @item size, s
 - Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - 
 - @item dither, d
 - Set the dither type.
 - 
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item none
 - @item ordered
 - @item random
 - @item error_diffusion
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is none.
 - 
 - @item filter, f
 - Set the resize filter type.
 - 
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item point
 - @item bilinear
 - @item bicubic
 - @item spline16
 - @item spline36
 - @item lanczos
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is bilinear.
 - 
 - @item range, r
 - Set the color range.
 - 
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item input
 - @item limited
 - @item full
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is same as input.
 - 
 - @item primaries, p
 - Set the color primaries.
 - 
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item input
 - @item 709
 - @item unspecified
 - @item 170m
 - @item 240m
 - @item 2020
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is same as input.
 - 
 - @item transfer, t
 - Set the transfer characteristics.
 - 
 - Possible values are:
 - @table @var
 - @item input
 - @item 709
 - @item unspecified
 - @item 601
 - @item linear
 - @item 2020_10
 - @item 2020_12
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is same as input.
 - 
 - @item matrix, m
 - Set the colorspace matrix.
 - 
 - Possible value are:
 - @table @var
 - @item input
 - @item 709
 - @item unspecified
 - @item 470bg
 - @item 170m
 - @item 2020_ncl
 - @item 2020_cl
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default is same as input.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
 - containing the following constants:
 - 
 - @table @var
 - @item in_w
 - @item in_h
 - The input width and height
 - 
 - @item iw
 - @item ih
 - These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
 - 
 - @item out_w
 - @item out_h
 - The output (scaled) width and height
 - 
 - @item ow
 - @item oh
 - These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
 - 
 - @item a
 - The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
 - 
 - @item sar
 - input sample aspect ratio
 - 
 - @item dar
 - The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
 - 
 - @item hsub
 - @item vsub
 - horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - 
 - @item ohsub
 - @item ovsub
 - horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
 - pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @end table
 - 
 - @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
 - 
 - @chapter Video Sources
 - @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
 - 
 - Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
 - 
 - @section buffer
 - 
 - Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
 - 
 - This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
 - through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item video_size
 - Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
 - syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - 
 - @item width
 - The input video width.
 - 
 - @item height
 - The input video height.
 - 
 - @item pix_fmt
 - A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
 - It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
 - name.
 - 
 - @item time_base
 - Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
 - 
 - @item frame_rate
 - Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
 - 
 - @item pixel_aspect, sar
 - The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
 - 
 - @item sws_param
 - Specify the optional parameters to be used for the scale filter which
 - is automatically inserted when an input change is detected in the
 - input size or format.
 - @end table
 - 
 - For example:
 - @example
 - buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
 - @end example
 - 
 - will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
 - with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
 - square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
 - Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
 - (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
 - this example corresponds to:
 - @example
 - buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
 - @end example
 - 
 - Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
 - syntax is deprecated:
 - 
 - @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}[:@var{sws_param}]
 - 
 - @section cellauto
 - 
 - Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
 - 
 - The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
 - @option{filename}, and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
 - not specified an initial state is created randomly.
 - 
 - At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
 - the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
 - frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
 - 
 - This source accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item filename, f
 - Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
 - the specified file.
 - In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
 - cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
 - file will be ignored.
 - 
 - @item pattern, p
 - Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
 - the specified string.
 - 
 - Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
 - cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
 - string will be ignored.
 - 
 - @item rate, r
 - Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
 - Default is 25.
 - 
 - @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
 - Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
 - is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
 - 1/PHI.
 - 
 - This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
 - 
 - @item random_seed, seed
 - Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
 - included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
 - set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
 - effort basis.
 - 
 - @item rule
 - Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
 - Default value is 110.
 - 
 - @item size, s
 - Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - 
 - If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
 - by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
 - height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
 - 
 - If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
 - pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
 - larger row.
 - 
 - If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
 - defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
 - 
 - @item scroll
 - If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
 - have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
 - written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
 - Defaults to 1.
 - 
 - @item start_full, full
 - If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
 - outputting the first frame.
 - This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
 - 
 - @item stitch
 - If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
 - This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
 - size 200x400.
 - @example
 - cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
 - ratio of 2/3:
 - @example
 - cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
 - centered on an initial row with width 100:
 - @example
 - cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
 - @example
 - cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section mandelbrot
 - 
 - Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
 - point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
 - 
 - This source accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item end_pts
 - Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
 - 
 - @item end_scale
 - Set the terminal scale value.
 - Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
 - 
 - @item inner
 - Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
 - Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
 - 
 - It shall assume one of the following values:
 - @table @option
 - @item black
 - Set black mode.
 - @item convergence
 - Show time until convergence.
 - @item mincol
 - Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
 - @item period
 - Set period mode.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @var{mincol}.
 - 
 - @item bailout
 - Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
 - 
 - @item maxiter
 - Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
 - algorithm. Default value is 7189.
 - 
 - @item outer
 - Set outer coloring mode.
 - It shall assume one of following values:
 - @table @option
 - @item iteration_count
 - Set iteration cound mode.
 - @item normalized_iteration_count
 - set normalized iteration count mode.
 - @end table
 - Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
 - 
 - @item rate, r
 - Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
 - value is "25".
 - 
 - @item size, s
 - Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video
 - size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. Default value is "640x480".
 - 
 - @item start_scale
 - Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
 - 
 - @item start_x
 - Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
 - -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
 - 
 - @item start_y
 - Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
 - -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section mptestsrc
 - 
 - Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
 - 
 - The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
 - This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
 - 
 - This source accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item rate, r
 - Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
 - generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
 - @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
 - number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
 - "25".
 - 
 - @item duration, d
 - Set the duration of the sourced video. See
 - @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
 - for the accepted syntax.
 - 
 - If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
 - supposed to be generated forever.
 - 
 - @item test, t
 - 
 - Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
 - @table @option
 - @item dc_luma
 - @item dc_chroma
 - @item freq_luma
 - @item freq_chroma
 - @item amp_luma
 - @item amp_chroma
 - @item cbp
 - @item mv
 - @item ring1
 - @item ring2
 - @item all
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Some examples:
 - @example
 - mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
 - @end example
 - 
 - will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
 - 
 - @section frei0r_src
 - 
 - Provide a frei0r source.
 - 
 - To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
 - header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
 - 
 - This source accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item size
 - The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - 
 - @item framerate
 - The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
 - @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
 - 
 - @item filter_name
 - The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
 - how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
 - documentation.
 - 
 - @item filter_params
 - A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
 - and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
 - @example
 - frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
 - @end example
 - 
 - @section life
 - 
 - Generate a life pattern.
 - 
 - This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
 - 
 - The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
 - which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
 - interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
 - horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
 - 
 - At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
 - which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
 - cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
 - the rule to adopt.
 - 
 - This source accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item filename, f
 - Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
 - each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
 - is used to delimit the end of each row.
 - 
 - If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
 - randomly.
 - 
 - @item rate, r
 - Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
 - Default is 25.
 - 
 - @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
 - Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
 - floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
 - It is ignored when a file is specified.
 - 
 - @item random_seed, seed
 - Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
 - included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
 - set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
 - effort basis.
 - 
 - @item rule
 - Set the life rule.
 - 
 - A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
 - where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
 - @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
 - live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
 - which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
 - "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
 - 
 - Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
 - high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
 - for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
 - the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
 - higher number of neighbor cells.
 - For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
 - rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
 - 
 - Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
 - rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
 - cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
 - a dead cell.
 - 
 - @item size, s
 - Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - 
 - If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
 - same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
 - the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
 - that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
 - 
 - If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
 - (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
 - 
 - @item stitch
 - If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
 - top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
 - 
 - @item mold
 - Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
 - @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
 - value from 0 to 255.
 - 
 - @item life_color
 - Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
 - 
 - @item death_color
 - Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
 - used to represent a dead cell.
 - 
 - @item mold_color
 - Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
 - 
 - For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the "Color" section in the
 - ffmpeg-utils manual.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
 - 300x300 pixels:
 - @example
 - life=f=pattern:s=300x300
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
 - @example
 - life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
 - @example
 - life=rule=S14/B34
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
 - @example
 - ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{allrgb}
 - @anchor{allyuv}
 - @anchor{color}
 - @anchor{haldclutsrc}
 - @anchor{nullsrc}
 - @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
 - @anchor{smptebars}
 - @anchor{smptehdbars}
 - @anchor{testsrc}
 - @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc
 - 
 - The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
 - 
 - The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
 - 
 - The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
 - 
 - The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
 - @ref{haldclut} filter.
 - 
 - The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
 - mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
 - source for filters which ignore the input data.
 - 
 - The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
 - detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
 - stripe from top to bottom.
 - 
 - The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
 - the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
 - 
 - The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
 - the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
 - 
 - The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
 - color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
 - intended for testing purposes.
 - 
 - The sources accept the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item color, c
 - Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
 - source. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
 - ffmpeg-utils manual.
 - 
 - @item level
 - Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
 - source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
 - pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
 - coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
 - 
 - @item size, s
 - Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - The default value is @code{320x240}.
 - 
 - This option is not available with the @code{haldclutsrc} filter.
 - 
 - @item rate, r
 - Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
 - generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
 - @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
 - number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
 - "25".
 - 
 - @item sar
 - Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
 - 
 - @item duration, d
 - Set the duration of the sourced video. See
 - @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
 - for the accepted syntax.
 - 
 - If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
 - supposed to be generated forever.
 - 
 - @item decimals, n
 - Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
 - @code{testsrc} source.
 - 
 - The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
 - timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
 - value. Default value is 0.
 - @end table
 - 
 - For example the following:
 - @example
 - testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
 - @end example
 - 
 - will generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
 - 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second.
 - 
 - The following graph description will generate a red source
 - with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
 - frames per second.
 - @example
 - color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
 - @end example
 - 
 - If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
 - following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
 - the @code{geq} filter:
 - @example
 - nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
 - @end example
 - 
 - @subsection Commands
 - 
 - The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item c, color
 - Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
 - corresponding @option{color} option.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
 - 
 - @chapter Video Sinks
 - @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
 - 
 - Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
 - 
 - @section buffersink
 - 
 - Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
 - graph.
 - 
 - This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
 - through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
 - or the options system.
 - 
 - It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
 - defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
 - parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
 - 
 - @section nullsink
 - 
 - Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
 - mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
 - tools.
 - 
 - @c man end VIDEO SINKS
 - 
 - @chapter Multimedia Filters
 - @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
 - 
 - Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
 - 
 - @section aphasemeter
 - 
 - Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio phase.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item rate, r
 - Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
 - 
 - @item size, s
 - Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - Default value is @code{800x400}.
 - 
 - @item rc
 - @item gc
 - @item bc
 - Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
 - @code{7} and @code{1}.
 - Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
 - 
 - @item mpc
 - Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
 - @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase} which
 - represents mean phase of current audio frame. Value is in range @code{[-1, 1]}.
 - The @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase and
 - @code{1} means channels are in phase.
 - 
 - @section avectorscope
 - 
 - Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
 - scope.
 - 
 - The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
 - audio stream. A monoaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
 - signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
 - as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
 - If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
 - indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item mode, m
 - Set the vectorscope mode.
 - 
 - Available values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item lissajous
 - Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
 - 
 - @item lissajous_xy
 - Same as above but not rotated.
 - 
 - @item polar
 - Shape resembling half of circle.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
 - 
 - @item size, s
 - Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - Default value is @code{400x400}.
 - 
 - @item rate, r
 - Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
 - 
 - @item rc
 - @item gc
 - @item bc
 - @item ac
 - Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
 - @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
 - Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
 - 
 - @item rf
 - @item gf
 - @item bf
 - @item af
 - Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
 - @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
 - Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
 - 
 - @item zoom
 - Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[1, 10]}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
 - @example
 - ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
 -              [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section concat
 - 
 - Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
 - other.
 - 
 - The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
 - segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
 - also be the number of streams at output.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item n
 - Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
 - 
 - @item v
 - Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
 - streams in each segment. Default is 1.
 - 
 - @item a
 - Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
 - streams in each segment. Default is 0.
 - 
 - @item unsafe
 - Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
 - @var{a} audio outputs.
 - 
 - There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
 - segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
 - segment, etc.
 - 
 - Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
 - reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
 - related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
 - concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
 - stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
 - audio streams with silence.
 - 
 - For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
 - 
 - All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
 - filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
 - streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
 - audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
 - explicitly by the user.
 - 
 - Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
 - at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
 - (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
 -   '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
 -    concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
 -   -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
 - (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
 - @example
 - movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
 - movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
 - [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
 - @end example
 - Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
 - do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{ebur128}
 - @section ebur128
 - 
 - EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as input and outputs
 - it unchanged. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
 - Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
 - Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
 - 
 - The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
 - time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
 - message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
 - unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
 - short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
 - the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds).
 - 
 - More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
 - @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item video
 - Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
 - option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
 - activated. Default is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item size
 - Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
 - option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
 - 
 - @item meter
 - Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
 - @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
 - other integer value between this range is allowed.
 - 
 - @item metadata
 - Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
 - into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
 - in metadata.  All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
 - 
 - Default is @code{0}.
 - 
 - @item framelog
 - Force the frame logging level.
 - 
 - Available values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item info
 - information logging level
 - @item verbose
 - verbose logging level
 - @end table
 - 
 - By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
 - the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
 - 
 - @item peak
 - Set peak mode(s).
 - 
 - Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
 - values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item none
 - Disable any peak mode (default).
 - @item sample
 - Enable sample-peak mode.
 - 
 - Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
 - for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
 - @item true
 - Enable true-peak mode.
 - 
 - If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
 - stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
 - (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
 - This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item dualmono
 - Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
 - on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
 - If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
 - Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
 - 
 - @item panlaw
 - Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
 - This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
 - @example
 - ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section interleave, ainterleave
 - 
 - Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
 - 
 - @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
 - 
 - These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
 - queued frame to the output.
 - 
 - Input streams must have a well defined, monotonically increasing frame
 - timestamp values.
 - 
 - In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
 - at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
 - input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
 - 
 - For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
 - which always drop input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
 - reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
 - to output until the input will send an end-of-stream signal.
 - 
 - Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
 - frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
 - the queue is already filled.
 - 
 - These filters accept the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item nb_inputs, n
 - Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Add flickering blur effect:
 - @example
 - select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section perms, aperms
 - 
 - Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
 - 
 - These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
 - following filter in the filtergraph.
 - 
 - The filters accept the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item mode
 - Select the permissions mode.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item none
 - Do nothing. This is the default.
 - @item ro
 - Set all the output frames read-only.
 - @item rw
 - Set all the output frames directly writable.
 - @item toggle
 - Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
 - @item random
 - Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item seed
 - Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
 - @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
 - @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
 - basis.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
 - following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
 - following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
 - perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
 - 
 - @section realtime, arealtime
 - 
 - Slow down filtering to match real time approximatively.
 - 
 - These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
 - match the output rate with the input timestamps.
 - They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
 - 
 - They accept the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item limit
 - Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
 - a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section select, aselect
 - 
 - Select frames to pass in output.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item expr, e
 - Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
 - 
 - If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
 - 
 - If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
 - first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
 - @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
 - 
 - For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
 - @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
 - 
 - @item outputs, n
 - Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
 - frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The expression can contain the following constants:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item n
 - The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
 - 
 - @item selected_n
 - The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
 - 
 - @item prev_selected_n
 - The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
 - 
 - @item TB
 - The timebase of the input timestamps.
 - 
 - @item pts
 - The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
 - expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
 - 
 - @item t
 - The PTS of the filtered video frame,
 - expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
 - 
 - @item prev_pts
 - The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
 - 
 - @item prev_selected_pts
 - The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
 - 
 - @item prev_selected_t
 - The PTS of the last previously selected video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
 - 
 - @item start_pts
 - The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
 - 
 - @item start_t
 - The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
 - 
 - @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
 - The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
 - values:
 - @table @option
 - @item I
 - @item P
 - @item B
 - @item S
 - @item SI
 - @item SP
 - @item BI
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
 - The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
 - @table @option
 - @item PROGRESSIVE
 - The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
 - @item TOPFIRST
 - The frame is top-field-first.
 - @item BOTTOMFIRST
 - The frame is bottom-field-first.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
 - the number of selected samples before the current frame
 - 
 - @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
 - the number of samples in the current frame
 - 
 - @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
 - the input sample rate
 - 
 - @item key
 - This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
 - 
 - @item pos
 - the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
 - is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
 - 
 - @item scene @emph{(video only)}
 - value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
 - probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
 - value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
 - 
 - @item concatdec_select
 - The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
 - inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
 - in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
 - generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
 - interval.
 - 
 - This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
 - and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
 - present in the decoded frames.
 - 
 - The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
 - start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
 - than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
 - missing.
 - 
 - That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
 - interval set by the concat demuxer.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - The default value of the select expression is "1".
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Select all frames in input:
 - @example
 - select
 - @end example
 - 
 - The example above is the same as:
 - @example
 - select=1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Skip all frames:
 - @example
 - select=0
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Select only I-frames:
 - @example
 - select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Select one frame every 100:
 - @example
 - select='not(mod(n\,100))'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
 - @example
 - select=between(t\,10\,20)
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Select only I frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
 - @example
 - select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
 - @example
 - select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
 - @example
 - aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
 - @end example
 - 
 - Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
 - choice.
 - 
 - @item
 - Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
 - @example
 - select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
 - outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section sendcmd, asendcmd
 - 
 - Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
 - 
 - These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
 - filtergraph.
 - 
 - @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
 - @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
 - from that they act the same way.
 - 
 - The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
 - with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
 - @var{filename} option.
 - 
 - These filters accept the following options:
 - @table @option
 - @item commands, c
 - Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
 - @item filename, f
 - Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
 - filters.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Commands syntax
 - 
 - A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
 - specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
 - particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
 - is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
 - interval.
 - 
 - An interval is specified by the following syntax:
 - @example
 - @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
 - @end example
 - 
 - The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
 - @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
 - 
 - The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
 - it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
 - the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
 - @var{END}.
 - 
 - @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
 - specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval.  The
 - syntax of a command specification is given by:
 - @example
 - [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
 - @end example
 - 
 - @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
 - the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
 - be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
 - enclosed between "[" and "]".
 - 
 - The following flags are recognized:
 - @table @option
 - @item enter
 - The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
 - specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
 - previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
 - current is.
 - 
 - @item leave
 - The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
 - specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
 - previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
 - current is not.
 - @end table
 - 
 - If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
 - assumed.
 - 
 - @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
 - the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
 - 
 - @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
 - 
 - @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
 - the given @var{COMMAND}.
 - 
 - Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
 - sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
 - are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
 - 
 - A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
 - follows:
 - @example
 - @var{COMMAND_FLAG}  ::= "enter" | "leave"
 - @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
 - @var{COMMAND}       ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
 - @var{COMMANDS}      ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
 - @var{INTERVAL}      ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
 - @var{INTERVALS}     ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
 - @end example
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
 - @example
 - asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
 - @example
 - # show text in the interval 5-10
 - 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
 -          [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
 - 
 - # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
 - 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
 -           [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
 -           [leave] hue s 1,
 -           [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
 - 
 - # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
 - 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
 - @end example
 - 
 - A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
 - stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
 - @example
 - sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @anchor{setpts}
 - @section setpts, asetpts
 - 
 - Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
 - 
 - @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
 - 
 - This filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item expr
 - The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
 - constants:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item FRAME_RATE
 - frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
 - 
 - @item PTS
 - The presentation timestamp in input
 - 
 - @item N
 - The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
 - not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
 - 
 - @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
 - The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
 - audio)
 - 
 - @item NB_SAMPLES, S
 - The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
 - 
 - @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
 - The audio sample rate.
 - 
 - @item STARTPTS
 - The PTS of the first frame.
 - 
 - @item STARTT
 - the time in seconds of the first frame
 - 
 - @item INTERLACED
 - State whether the current frame is interlaced.
 - 
 - @item T
 - the time in seconds of the current frame
 - 
 - @item POS
 - original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
 - for the current frame
 - 
 - @item PREV_INPTS
 - The previous input PTS.
 - 
 - @item PREV_INT
 - previous input time in seconds
 - 
 - @item PREV_OUTPTS
 - The previous output PTS.
 - 
 - @item PREV_OUTT
 - previous output time in seconds
 - 
 - @item RTCTIME
 - The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
 - instead.
 - 
 - @item RTCSTART
 - The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
 - 
 - @item TB
 - The timebase of the input timestamps.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Start counting PTS from zero
 - @example
 - setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply fast motion effect:
 - @example
 - setpts=0.5*PTS
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply slow motion effect:
 - @example
 - setpts=2.0*PTS
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
 - @example
 - setpts=N/(25*TB)
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
 - @example
 - setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
 - @example
 - setpts=PTS+10/TB
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
 - @example
 - setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Generate timestamps by counting samples:
 - @example
 - asetpts=N/SR/TB
 - @end example
 - 
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section settb, asettb
 - 
 - Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
 - It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - 
 - @item expr, tb
 - The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
 - rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
 - timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
 - audio only). Default value is "intb".
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Set the timebase to 1/25:
 - @example
 - settb=expr=1/25
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Set the timebase to 1/10:
 - @example
 - settb=expr=0.1
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
 - @example
 - settb=1+0.001
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Set the timebase to 2*intb:
 - @example
 - settb=2*intb
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Set the default timebase value:
 - @example
 - settb=AVTB
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section showcqt
 - Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
 - logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
 - direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
 - is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
 - with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item size, s
 - Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
 - check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
 - 
 - @item fps, rate, r
 - Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
 - 
 - @item bar_h
 - Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
 - computes the bargraph height automatically.
 - 
 - @item axis_h
 - Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
 - the axis height automatically.
 - 
 - @item sono_h
 - Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
 - computes the sonogram height automatically.
 - 
 - @item fullhd
 - Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
 - instead. Default value is @code{1}.
 - 
 - @item sono_v, volume
 - Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
 - @table @option
 - @item bar_v
 - the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
 - @item frequency, freq, f
 - the frequency where it is evaluated
 - @item timeclamp, tc
 - the value of @var{timeclamp} option
 - @end table
 - and functions:
 - @table @option
 - @item a_weighting(f)
 - A-weighting of equal loudness
 - @item b_weighting(f)
 - B-weighting of equal loudness
 - @item c_weighting(f)
 - C-weighting of equal loudness.
 - @end table
 - Default value is @code{16}.
 - 
 - @item bar_v, volume2
 - Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
 - @table @option
 - @item sono_v
 - the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
 - @item frequency, freq, f
 - the frequency where it is evaluated
 - @item timeclamp, tc
 - the value of @var{timeclamp} option
 - @end table
 - and functions:
 - @table @option
 - @item a_weighting(f)
 - A-weighting of equal loudness
 - @item b_weighting(f)
 - B-weighting of equal loudness
 - @item c_weighting(f)
 - C-weighting of equal loudness.
 - @end table
 - Default value is @code{sono_v}.
 - 
 - @item sono_g, gamma
 - Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
 - higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
 - Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
 - 
 - @item bar_g, gamma2
 - Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
 - @code{[1, 7]}.
 - 
 - @item timeclamp, tc
 - Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
 - accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
 - event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
 - otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
 - (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.1, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
 - 
 - @item basefreq
 - Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
 - which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
 - 
 - @item endfreq
 - Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
 - which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
 - 
 - @item coeffclamp
 - This option is deprecated and ignored.
 - 
 - @item tlength
 - Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
 - trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
 - It can contain variables:
 - @table @option
 - @item frequency, freq, f
 - the frequency where it is evaluated
 - @item timeclamp, tc
 - the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
 - @end table
 - Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
 - 
 - @item count
 - Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
 - Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
 - 
 - @item fcount
 - Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
 - which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
 - 
 - @item fontfile
 - Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
 - use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
 - implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
 - option instead.
 - 
 - @item fontcolor
 - Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
 - integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
 - @table @option
 - @item frequency, freq, f
 - the frequency where it is evaluated
 - @item timeclamp, tc
 - the value of @var{timeclamp} option
 - @end table
 - and functions:
 - @table @option
 - @item midi(f)
 - midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
 - @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
 - red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
 - @end table
 - Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
 - st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
 - r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
 - 
 - @item axisfile
 - Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
 - @var{fontcolor} option.
 - 
 - @item axis, text
 - Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
 - the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
 - Default value is @code{1}.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
 - @example
 - ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
 - @example
 - ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Playing at 1280x720:
 - @example
 - ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Disable sonogram display:
 - @example
 - sono_h=0
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
 - @example
 - ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
 -                  asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
 - @example
 - ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
 -                  asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Custom volume:
 - @example
 - bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
 - @example
 - bar_g=2:sono_g=2
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Custom tlength equation:
 - @example
 - tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
 - @example
 - fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
 - @example
 - axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section showfreqs
 - 
 - Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
 - Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item size, s
 - Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - Default is @code{1024x512}.
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Set display mode.
 - This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item line
 - @item bar
 - @item dot
 - @end table
 - Default is @code{bar}.
 - 
 - @item ascale
 - Set amplitude scale.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item lin
 - Linear scale.
 - 
 - @item sqrt
 - Square root scale.
 - 
 - @item cbrt
 - Cubic root scale.
 - 
 - @item log
 - Logarithmic scale.
 - @end table
 - Default is @code{log}.
 - 
 - @item fscale
 - Set frequency scale.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item lin
 - Linear scale.
 - 
 - @item log
 - Logarithmic scale.
 - 
 - @item rlog
 - Reverse logarithmic scale.
 - @end table
 - Default is @code{lin}.
 - 
 - @item win_size
 - Set window size.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item w16
 - @item w32
 - @item w64
 - @item w128
 - @item w256
 - @item w512
 - @item w1024
 - @item w2048
 - @item w4096
 - @item w8192
 - @item w16384
 - @item w32768
 - @item w65536
 - @end table
 - Default is @code{w2048}
 - 
 - @item win_func
 - Set windowing function.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item rect
 - @item bartlett
 - @item hanning
 - @item hamming
 - @item blackman
 - @item welch
 - @item flattop
 - @item bharris
 - @item bnuttall
 - @item bhann
 - @item sine
 - @item nuttall
 - @item lanczos
 - @item gauss
 - @end table
 - Default is @code{hanning}.
 - 
 - @item overlap
 - Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
 - which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
 - 
 - @item averaging
 - Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
 - Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
 - 
 - @item colors
 - Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
 - draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
 - by white color.
 - 
 - @item cmode
 - Set channel display mode.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item combined
 - @item separate
 - @end table
 - Default is @code{combined}.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section showspectrum
 - 
 - Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
 - spectrum.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item size, s
 - Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - Default value is @code{640x512}.
 - 
 - @item slide
 - Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item replace
 - the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
 - @item scroll
 - the samples scroll from right to left
 - @item fullframe
 - frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @code{replace}.
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Specify display mode.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item combined
 - all channels are displayed in the same row
 - @item separate
 - all channels are displayed in separate rows
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{combined}.
 - 
 - @item color
 - Specify display color mode.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item channel
 - each channel is displayed in a separate color
 - @item intensity
 - each channel is is displayed using the same color scheme
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{channel}.
 - 
 - @item scale
 - Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item lin
 - linear
 - @item sqrt
 - square root, default
 - @item cbrt
 - cubic root
 - @item log
 - logarithmic
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
 - 
 - @item saturation
 - Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
 - alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
 - Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
 - Default value is @code{1}.
 - 
 - @item win_func
 - Set window function.
 - 
 - It accepts the following values:
 - @table @samp
 - @item none
 - No samples pre-processing (do not expect this to be faster)
 - @item hann
 - Hann window
 - @item hamming
 - Hamming window
 - @item blackman
 - Blackman window
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @code{hann}.
 - @end table
 - 
 - The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
 - section.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
 - @example
 - showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
 - @example
 - ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
 -              [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section showvolume
 - 
 - Convert input audio volume to a video output.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item rate, r
 - Set video rate.
 - 
 - @item b
 - Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
 - 
 - @item w
 - Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 1080]. Default is 400.
 - 
 - @item h
 - Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 100]. Default is 20.
 - 
 - @item f
 - Set fade, allowed range is [0.001, 1]. Default is 0.95.
 - 
 - @item c
 - Set volume color expression.
 - 
 - The expression can use the following variables:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item VOLUME
 - Current max volume of channel in dB.
 - 
 - @item CHANNEL
 - Current channel number, starting from 0.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @item t
 - If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
 - 
 - @item v
 - If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @section showwaves
 - 
 - Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item size, s
 - Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - Default value is @code{600x240}.
 - 
 - @item mode
 - Set display mode.
 - 
 - Available values are:
 - @table @samp
 - @item point
 - Draw a point for each sample.
 - 
 - @item line
 - Draw a vertical line for each sample.
 - 
 - @item p2p
 - Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
 - 
 - @item cline
 - Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
 - @end table
 - 
 - Default value is @code{point}.
 - 
 - @item n
 - Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
 - larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
 - integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
 - is not explicitly specified.
 - 
 - @item rate, r
 - Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
 - option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
 - 
 - @item split_channels
 - Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
 - 
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
 - at the same time:
 - @example
 - amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
 - frame rate of 30 frames per second:
 - @example
 - aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section showwavespic
 - 
 - Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
 - 
 - The filter accepts the following options:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item size, s
 - Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
 - @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
 - Default value is @code{600x240}.
 - 
 - @item split_channels
 - Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
 - @end table
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
 - in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section split, asplit
 - 
 - Split input into several identical outputs.
 - 
 - @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
 - 
 - The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
 - unspecified, it defaults to 2.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Create two separate outputs from the same input:
 - @example
 - [in] split [out0][out1]
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
 - outputs, like in:
 - @example
 - [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
 - one padded:
 - @example
 - [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
 - [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0    [cropout];
 - [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
 - @example
 - ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @section zmq, azmq
 - 
 - Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
 - filters in the filtergraph.
 - 
 - @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
 - must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
 - audio filters.
 - 
 - To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
 - headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
 - 
 - For more information about libzmq see:
 - @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
 - 
 - The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
 - receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
 - @option{bind_address} option.
 - 
 - The received message must be in the form:
 - @example
 - @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
 - @end example
 - 
 - @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
 - the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
 - 
 - @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
 - 
 - @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
 - given @var{COMMAND}.
 - 
 - Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
 - is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
 - will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
 - @example
 - @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
 - @var{MESSAGE}
 - @end example
 - 
 - @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
 - 
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
 - be used to send commands processed by these filters.
 - 
 - Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}
 - @example
 - ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
 - color=s=100x100:c=red  [l];
 - color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
 - nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
 - [bg][l]   overlay      [bg+l];
 - [bg+l][r] overlay=x=100 "
 - @end example
 - 
 - To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
 - command can be used:
 - @example
 - echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
 - @end example
 - 
 - To change the right side:
 - @example
 - echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
 - @end example
 - 
 - @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
 - 
 - @chapter Multimedia Sources
 - @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
 - 
 - Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
 - 
 - @section amovie
 - 
 - This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
 - stream by default.
 - 
 - @anchor{movie}
 - @section movie
 - 
 - Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
 - 
 - It accepts the following parameters:
 - 
 - @table @option
 - @item filename
 - The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
 - device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
 - 
 - @item format_name, f
 - Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
 - the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
 - format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
 - 
 - @item seek_point, sp
 - Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
 - starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
 - @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
 - postfix. The default value is "0".
 - 
 - @item streams, s
 - Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
 - separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
 - same order. The syntax is explained in the ``Stream specifiers''
 - section in the ffmpeg manual. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
 - respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
 - is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
 - 
 - @item stream_index, si
 - Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
 - the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
 - value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
 - audio instead of video.
 - 
 - @item loop
 - Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
 - If the value is less than 1, the stream will be read again and again.
 - Default value is "1".
 - 
 - Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
 - changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
 - @end table
 - 
 - It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
 - a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
 - @example
 - input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
 -                                     ^
 -                                     |
 - movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
 - @end example
 - @subsection Examples
 - 
 - @itemize
 - @item
 - Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
 - on top of the input labelled "in":
 - @example
 - movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
 - [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
 - [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
 - labelled "in":
 - @example
 - movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
 - [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
 - [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
 - @end example
 - 
 - @item
 - Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
 - dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
 - connected to the pad named "audio":
 - @example
 - movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
 - @end example
 - @end itemize
 - 
 - @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
 
 
  |